York Yvaa Iom

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 144
At a glance
Powered by AI
The document discusses safety guidelines for air-cooled screw liquid chillers and mentions hazards like refrigerants, materials under pressure, rotating components, high and low voltage.

Hazards like refrigerants, materials under pressure, rotating components, high and low voltage are mentioned.

Symbols indicating hazards, potential hazards and additional useful information are discussed.

AIR-COOLED SCREW

LIQUID CHILLERS
INSTALLATION, OPERATION, MAINTENANCE

Supersedes: 201.28-NM1.1 (812)

Form 201.28-NM1.1 (813)


035-23219-100

MODEL YVAA STYLE A


AIR-COOLED SCREW LIQUID CHILLERS WITH
VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE
FRAME SIZES 015 - 052
150 - 500 TONS
525 - 1750 KW
2 COMPRESSOR
50 AND 60 HZ

LD15045

HFC-134A

Issue Date:
August 29, 2013

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

IMPORTANT!

READ BEFORE PROCEEDING!


GENERAL SAFETY GUIDELINES
This equipment is a relatively complicated apparatus.
During installation, operation maintenance or service,
individuals may be exposed to certain components or
conditions including, but not limited to: refrigerants,
materials under pressure, rotating components, and
both high and low voltage. Each of these items has the
potential, if misused or handled improperly, to cause
bodily injury or death. It is the obligation and responsibility of operating/service personnel to identify and
recognize these inherent hazards, protect themselves,
and proceed safely in completing their tasks. Failure
to comply with any of these requirements could result
in serious damage to the equipment and the property in

which it is situated, as well as severe personal injury or


death to themselves and people at the site.
This document is intended for use by owner-authorized
operating/service personnel. It is expected that these
individuals possess independent training that will enable them to perform their assigned tasks properly and
safely. It is essential that, prior to performing any task
on this equipment, this individual shall have read and
understood this document and any referenced materials. This individual shall also be familiar with and
comply with all applicable governmental standards and
regulations pertaining to the task in question.

SAFETY SYMBOLS
The following symbols are used in this document to alert the reader to specific situations:
Indicates a possible hazardous situation
which will result in death or serious injury
if proper care is not taken.

Identifies a hazard which could lead to


damage to the machine, damage to other
equipment and/or environmental pollution if proper care is not taken or instructions and are not followed.

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which will result in possible injuries


or damage to equipment if proper care is
not taken.

Highlights additional information useful


to the technician in completing the work
being performed properly.

External wiring, unless specified as an optional connection in the manufacturers product line, is not
to be connected inside the control cabinet. Devices such as relays, switches, transducers and controls
and any external wiring must not be installed inside the micro panel. All wiring must be in accordance with Johnson Controls published specifications and must be performed only by a qualified
electrician. Johnson Controls will NOT be responsible for damage/problems resulting from improper
connections to the controls or application of improper control signals. Failure to follow this warning will void the manufacturers warranty and cause serious damage to property or personal injury.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

CHANGEABILITY OF THIS DOCUMENT


In complying with Johnson Controls policy for continuous product improvement, the information contained in this document is subject to change without
notice. Johnson Controls makes no commitment to
update or provide current information automatically to
the manual owner. Updated manuals, if applicable, can
be obtained by contacting the nearest Johnson Controls
Service office.
Operating/service personnel maintain responsibility for
the applicability of these documents to the equipment.
If there is any question regarding the applicability of

these documents, the technician should verify whether


the equipment has been modified and if current literature is available from the owner of the equipment prior
to performing any work on the chiller.
CHANGE BARS
Revisions made to this document are indicated with a
line along the left or right hand column in the area the
revision was made. These revisions are to technical information and any other changes in spelling, grammar
or formatting are not included.

The Control/VSD Cabinet contains lethal


high AC and DC voltages. Before performing service inside the cabinet, remove
the AC supply feeding the chiller and
verify using a non-contact voltage sensor.
The DC voltage on the VSD DC Bus will
take 5 minutes to bleed off, after AC
power is removed. Always check the DC
Bus Voltage with a Voltmeter to assure
the capacitor charge has bled off before
working on the system.
NEVER short out the DC Bus to discharge the filter capacitors.

NEVER place loose tools, debris, or any


objects inside the Control Panel/VSD
Cabinet.

NEVER allow the Control Panel VSD


Cabinet doors to remain open if there is
a potential for rain to enter the panel.
Keep doors closed and assure all latches
are engaged on each door unless the unit
is being serviced.
ALWAYS lockout the disconnect supplying AC to the chiller.

The 1L Line Inductor will reach operating


temperatures of over 150C (300F.) DO
NOT open panel doors during operation.
Assure the inductor is cool whenever
working near the inductor with power
OFF.

ASSOCIATED LITERATURE
MANUAL DESCRIPTION

FORM NUMBER

Equipment Pre-Startup and Startup Checklist

201.28-CL2

YVAA Frame Size 015 - 027, 2 Compressor 60 Hz (150-275 Tons)


YVAA Frame Size 054 - 098, 2 Compressor 50 Hz (525-950 KW)

201.28-RP1

JOHNSON CONTROLS

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

TABLE OF CONTENTS
SECTION 1 - GENERAL CHILLER INFORMATION AND SAFETY......................................................................... 9
Introduction........................................................................................................................................................ 9
Warranty............................................................................................................................................................ 9
Quality Assurance and Safety........................................................................................................................... 9
Fluorinated Greenhouse Gases...................................................................................................................... 10
Responsibility for Safety.................................................................................................................................. 10
About This Manual.......................................................................................................................................... 10
Misuse of Equipment....................................................................................................................................... 10
SECTION 2 - PRODUCT DESCRIPTION................................................................................................................13
General System Description............................................................................................................................ 13
Semi-Hermetic York Twin-Screw Compressors............................................................................................... 14
Evaporator....................................................................................................................................................... 15
Condenser....................................................................................................................................................... 15
Refrigerant Circuit........................................................................................................................................... 15
Electrical.......................................................................................................................................................... 15
Building Automation System Capabilities........................................................................................................ 15
Microcomputer Control Center........................................................................................................................ 16
Accessories and Options................................................................................................................................. 17
SECTION 3 - HANDLING AND STORAGE.............................................................................................................19
Delivery and Storage....................................................................................................................................... 19
Inspection........................................................................................................................................................ 19
Moving the Chiller............................................................................................................................................ 19
Lifting Weights................................................................................................................................................. 19
Lifting Unit....................................................................................................................................................... 20
Unit Removal From Shipping Container.......................................................................................................... 21
Lifting Using Lugs............................................................................................................................................ 22
Lifting Using Shackles..................................................................................................................................... 22
SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION.................................................................................................................................23
Location Requirements................................................................................................................................... 23
Outdoor Installations....................................................................................................................................... 23
Location Clearances........................................................................................................................................ 23
Vibration Isolators............................................................................................................................................ 24
Shipping Braces.............................................................................................................................................. 24
Chilled Liquid Piping........................................................................................................................................ 24
Water Treatment.............................................................................................................................................. 26
Pipework Arrangement.................................................................................................................................... 26
Minimum Water Volume.................................................................................................................................. 26
Leaving Water Temperature Out of Range...................................................................................................... 26
Flow Rate Out of Range.................................................................................................................................. 26
Thermal Storage.............................................................................................................................................. 27
Variable Primary Flow .................................................................................................................................... 27
Connection Types and Sizes........................................................................................................................... 27
Evaporator Connections.................................................................................................................................. 27
Refrigerant Relief Valve Piping........................................................................................................................ 29
Electrical Connection....................................................................................................................................... 29

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

TABLE OF CONTENTS (CONT'D)


Power Wiring................................................................................................................................................... 29
Power Supply Wiring....................................................................................................................................... 30
115VAC Control Supply Transformer............................................................................................................... 30
Control Wiring.................................................................................................................................................. 30
Volts Free Contacts......................................................................................................................................... 30
System Inputs.................................................................................................................................................. 30
Power Supply Wiring....................................................................................................................................... 32
Customer Control Wiring................................................................................................................................. 33
SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA............................................................................................................................49
Nomenclature.................................................................................................................................................. 49
SECTION 6 - COMMISSIONING.............................................................................................................................81
Preparation...................................................................................................................................................... 81
First Time Start Up.......................................................................................................................................... 83
SECTION 7 - OPERATION......................................................................................................................................85
Operating Controls.......................................................................................................................................... 85
Basic Operating Sequence.............................................................................................................................. 87
Unit Warning.................................................................................................................................................... 87
Unit Safeties.................................................................................................................................................... 88
System Safeties (Faults)................................................................................................................................. 89
SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL...................................................................................................................................95
SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE...............................................................................................................................129
General Requirements.................................................................................................................................. 129
Refrigerant Removal, Evacuation and Charging a YVAA Chiller .................................................................. 130
Microchannel Coil Cleaning........................................................................................................................... 131
Maintenance Requirements for YVAA Chillers.............................................................................................. 132
SECTION 10 - DECOMMISSIONING, DISMANTLING AND DISPOSAL............................................................. 141
General.......................................................................................................................................................... 141

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

LIST OF FIGURES
FIGURE 1 - YVAA Air-Cooled Screw Liquid Chiller with Variable Speed Drive 13
FIGURE 2 - Chiller Control System14
FIGURE 3 - View of York Control Center User Interface16
FIGURE 4 - Proper Lifting of YVAA Chiller20
FIGURE 5 - Acceptable Minimum Clearances Around/Between Unit(s) 24
FIGURE 6 - Pipework Arrangement26
FIGURE 7 - Leaving Water Temperature Out of Range Suggested Layout 26
FIGURE 8 - Suggested Layout For Applications With A Flow Rate Less Than
The Evaporator Minimum Allowable Flow Rate27
FIGURE 9 - Suggested Layout For Applications With A Flow Rate Less Than
The Evaporator Minimum Allowable Flow Rate27
FIGURE 10 - Victaulic Groove27
FIGURE 11 - Flange For GB Vessels28
FIGURE 12 - Flange Attachment29
FIGURE 13 - Power Wiring - 2 Compressor Connections32
FIGURE 14 - Customer Control Connections 33
FIGURE 15 - YVAA Dimensions55
FIGURE 16 - Keyboard and Display85

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

LIST OF TABLES
TABLE 1 - Minimum Evaporator Tube Removal Clearance24
TABLE 2 - Evaporator Flange Dimensions For GB Units28
TABLE 3 - Electrical Lug Data34
TABLE 4 - Physical Data50
TABLE 5 - Unit Rigging56
TABLE 6 - Isolator Selection and Mounting Locations62
TABLE 7 - Low Differential Oil Pressure Cutout91
TABLE 8 - Start Inhibit Sensor Thresholds92
TABLE 9 - Sensor Min/Max Outputs102
TABLE 10 - Setpoint Limits 113
TABLE 11 - Programmable Operating Parameters 116
TABLE 12 - Printout Types124
TABLE 13 - Troubleshooting Guide133
TABLE 14 - Temperature Input Voltage Sensor
(Measured Signal To Shield At The Sensor)136
TABLE 15 - Outside Air Temperature Sensor Input Voltage
(Measured Signal To Shield At The Sensor)137
TABLE 16 - Pressure Transducer Output Voltage
(Measured Signal To Return At The Transducer)138
TABLE 17 - Motor Temperature Sensor Resistance
(Check At The Motor)139
TABLE 18 - SI Metric Conversion143

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 1 - GENERAL CHILLER INFORMATION AND SAFETY


INTRODUCTION
YORK YVAA chillers are manufactured to the highest
design and construction standards to ensure high performance, reliability and adaptability to all types of air
conditioning installations.
The unit is intended for cooling water or glycol solutions and is not suitable for purposes other than those
specified in this manual.
This manual contains all the information required for
correct installation and commissioning of the unit, together with operating and maintenance instructions.
The manual should be read thoroughly before attempting to operate or service the unit.
All procedures detailed in the manual, including installation, commissioning and maintenance tasks must
only be performed by suitably trained and qualified
personnel.
The manufacturer will not be liable for any injury or
damage caused by incorrect installation, commissioning, operation or maintenance resulting from a failure
to follow the procedures and instructions detailed in
the manual.
WARRANTY
Johnson Controls warrants YVAA chillers in accordance with the "Limited Warranty Engineered Systems
Equipment" procedure, Form 50.05-NM2.
Johnson Controls warrants all equipment and materials against defects in workmanship and materials for
a period of eighteen months from date of shipment or
12 months from date of startup, whichever comes first,
unless labor or extended warranty has been purchased
as part of the contract.
The warranty is limited to parts only replacement and
shipping of any faulty part, or sub-assembly, which has
failed due to poor quality or manufacturing errors. All
claims must be supported by evidence that the failure
has occurred within the warranty period, and that the
unit has been operated within the designed parameters
specified.
All warranty claims must specify the unit model, serial
number, order number and run hours/starts. Model and
serial number information is printed on the unit identification plate.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

The unit warranty will be void if any modification to


the unit is carried out without prior written approval
from Johnson Controls.
For warranty purposes, the following conditions must
be satisfied:
The initial start of the unit must be carried out
by trained personnel from an authorized Johnson
Controls Service Center. Refer to SECTION 6 COMMISSIONING on Page 81 for more information.
Only genuine YORK approved spare parts, oils,
coolants, and refrigerants must be used.
All the scheduled maintenance operations detailed
in this manual must be performed at the specified
times by suitably trained and qualified personnel.
See SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE on Page 129
for more information.
Failure to satisfy any of these conditions will
automatically void the warranty. Refer to Form
50.05-NM2 for complete details.
QUALITY ASSURANCE AND SAFETY
YVAA chillers are designed within EN ISO 9001 and
built within an EN ISO 9002 accredited manufacturing
organization.
Units conform with the following European Directives:
Machinery Directive (2006/42/EC)
EMC Directive (2004/108/EC)
Pressure Equipment Directive (97/23/EC)
Low Voltage Directive (2006/95/EC)
Safety Code for
(EN378-2(2008))

Mechanical

Refrigeration

CE/PED marked units conform to the following standards:


Machinery Directive (2006/42/EC).
EMC Directive (2004/108/EC).
Pressure Equipment Directive (97/23/EC).
Low Voltage Directive (2006/95/EC).
Safety Code for
(EN378-2(2008)).

Mechanical

Refrigeration

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 1 - GENERAL CHILLER INFORMATION AND SAFETY

ETL/ASME marked units conform to the following


standards:
ANSI/ASHRAE 15 Safety Code for Mechanical
Refrigeration.
ANSI/ASHRAE 34 Number Designation and
Safety Classification of Refrigerants.
ANSI/NFPA 70 National Electrical Code
(N.E.C.).

MISUSE OF EQUIPMENT
Suitability for Application

GB5226.1 Safety of machinery- Electrical equipment of machines Part 1: General requirements.

The unit is intended for cooling water or glycol solutions and is not suitable for purposes other than those
specified in these instructions. Any use of the equipment other than its intended use, or operation of the
equipment contrary to the relevant procedures may result in injury to the operator, or damage to the equipment.

GB25131 Safety requirements for water chiller


(heat pump) using the vapor compression cycle.

The unit must not be operated outside the design parameters specified in this manual.

ASME Boiler and Pressure Vessel Code, Section


VIII, Division 1.
GB marked units conform to the following standards:

FLUORINATED GREENHOUSE GASES


This equipment contains fluorinated greenhouse
gases covered by the Kyoto Protocol.
The global warming potential of the refrigerant
(RI34a) used in this unit is 1300.
The refrigerant quantity is stated in Table 4 on
page 50 of this document.
The fluorinated greenhouse gases in this equipment may not be vented to the atmosphere.
This equipment should only be serviced by qualified technicians.
RESPONSIBILITY FOR SAFETY
Every care has been taken in the design and manufacture of the unit to ensure compliance with the safety
requirements listed above. However, the individual
operating or working on any machinery is primarily
responsible for:
Personal safety, safety of other personnel, and the
machinery.
Correct utilization of the machinery in accordance
with the procedures detailed in the manual.
ABOUT THIS MANUAL
The contents of this manual include suggested best
working practices and procedures. These are issued for
guidance only, and they do not take precedence over
the above stated individual responsibility and/or local
safety regulations.

10

This manual and any other document supplied with


the unit are the property of Johnson Controls which reserves all rights. They may not be reproduced, in whole
or in part, without prior written authorization from an
authorized Johnson Controls representative.

Structural Support
Structural support of the unit must be provided as indicated in these instructions. Failure to provide proper
support may result in injury to the operator, or damage
to the equipment and/or building.
Mechanical Strength
The unit is not designed to withstand loads or stresses
from adjacent equipment, pipework or structures. Additional components must not be mounted on the unit.
Any such extraneous loads may cause structural failure
and may result in injury to the operator, or damage to
the equipment.
General Access
There are a number of areas and features, which may
be a hazard and potentially cause injury when working
on the unit unless suitable safety precautions are taken.
It is important to ensure access to the unit is restricted
to suitably qualified persons who are familiar with the
potential hazards and precautions necessary for safe
operation and maintenance of equipment containing
high temperatures, pressures and voltages.
Pressure Systems
The unit contains refrigerant vapor and liquid under pressure, release of which can be a danger and cause injury.
The user should ensure that care is taken during installation, operation and maintenance to avoid damage to the
pressure system. No attempt should be made to gain access to the component parts of the pressure system other
than by suitably trained and qualified personnel.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 1 - GENERAL CHILLER INFORMATION AND SAFETY

Electrical

Emergency Shutdown

The unit must be grounded. No installation or maintenance work should be attempted on the electrical
equipment without first switching power OFF, isolating and locking-off the power supply. Servicing and
maintenance on live equipment must not be attempted.
No attempt should be made to gain access to the control panel or electrical enclosures during normal operation of the unit.

In case of emergency , the control panel is fitted with


an incoming supply circuit breaker with a red and yellow handle which can be used as the emergency stop
device. When operated it removes the electrical supply
to the inverter, fans, and control circuit thus shutting
down the unit.
Safety Labels

Rotating Parts

White symbol on blue background.

Fan guards must be fitted at all times and not removed


unless the power supply has been isolated. If ductwork
is to be fitted, requiring the wire fan guards to be removed, alternative safety measures must be taken to
protect against the risk of injury from rotating fans.

For safe operation, read the Instructions


first.

Sharp Edges
The fins on the air-cooled condenser coils have sharp
metal edges. Reasonable care should be taken when
working in contact with the coils to avoid the risk of
minor abrasions and lacerations. The use of gloves is
recommended.
Frame rails, brakes, and other components may also
have sharp edges. Reasonable care should be taken
when working in contact with any components to avoid
risk of minor abrasions and lacerations.
Refrigerants and Oils
Refrigerants and oils used in the unit are generally nontoxic, non-flammable and non-corrosive, and pose no
special safety hazards. Use of gloves and safety glasses
is, however, recommended when working on the unit.
The buildup of refrigerant vapor, from a leak for example, does pose a risk of asphyxiation in confined or
enclosed spaces and attention should be given to good
ventilation.
High Temperature and Pressure Cleaning
High temperature and pressure cleaning methods
(e.g. steam cleaning) should not be used on any part
of the pressure system as this may cause operation of
the pressure relief device(s). Detergents and solvents,
which may cause corrosion, should also be avoided.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

Black symbol on yellow background.


Warning: This machine may start automatically without prior warning
Black symbol on yellow background.
Warning: Hot surface.
Black symbol on yellow background.
Warning: Safety relief valve may discharge gas or liquid without prior warning.
Black symbol on yellow background.
Warning: Isolate all electrical sources of
supply before opening or removing the
cover, as lethal voltages may exist.
Black symbol on yellow background.
General attention symbol.
Black symbol on yellow background.
Warning: On isolating the supply it may
take up to 300 seconds for the capacitor
voltage to fall below 50 volts.

11

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 2 - PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

LD15045

Figure 1 - YVAA AIR-COOLED SCREW LIQUID CHILLER WITH VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE

YORK YVAA R134a chillers are designed for water


or glycol cooling. All units are designed to be located
outside on the roof of a building or at ground level.
The units are completely assembled with all interconnecting refrigerant piping and internal wiring, ready
for field installation.
Prior to delivery, the unit is pressure tested, evacuated,
and fully charged with refrigerant and oil in each of the
two independent refrigerant circuits. After assembly,
an operational test is performed with water flowing
through the evaporator to ensure that each refrigerant
circuit operates correctly.
The unit structure is manufactured from heavy gauge,
galvanized steel. Many external structural parts are
coated with Champagne baked-on enamel powder
paint.
All exposed power wiring is routed through liquidtight, non-metallic conduit.
GENERAL SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The YVAA Chiller combines the best of modern screw
compressor design with the latest technology in variJOHNSON CONTROLS

able speed drives. The result is superior control and


efficiency in real world conditions. The VSD enables
slowing the speed of the compressor to match the load
on the system resulting in precise chilled liquid control, minimized sound, maximum energy efficiency,
and reduced cost of ownership. The VSD also provides
soft starts with no electrical inrush. The lack of heat
build-up on start also enables required off time between starts to be reduced to a period of two minutes.
The YVAA Air-Cooled Screw Chiller utilizes many
components, which are the same or nearly the same as
a standard screw chiller of a similar size. This includes
modular frame rails, condenser, fans, compressors and
evaporator.
The chiller consists of two screw compressors in a corresponding number of separate refrigerant circuits, a
hybrid falling film evaporator, an air-cooled condenser,
receiver/flash tanks, feed valves, oil separators, and
compressor mufflers. Oil separators utilize no moving
parts. Oil cooling is accomplished by refrigerant leaving the eductor flashing in the suction line which cools
the oil, motor and compressor.

13

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 2 - PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

INPUTS
Pressure Transducers
Temperature Sensors
Switches
Liquid Flow
High Pressure
Start/Stop
Level
Customer Supplied
Contacts

OUTPUTS
Relay Output Board)
Solenoids
Contactors
Alarm
Pump
Compressor Heater
Run Status
Evaporator Heater

CONTROL
PANEL
Chiller Control
Board)
Microprocessor
User Interface
Display and
Keypad

VSD
VSD Logic Board
SCR Trigger Board
Power Components
PWM (Speed Control)

COMMUNICATIONS
Building Automation
Printer Modem

DISPLAY

MOTOR

KEYPAD

LD15028

3 Phase Power Line


Compressor 1
Power Driver
(IGBT)

AC/DC Rectifier

Rectifier Controller
SCR Trigger Board

Compressor 2

IGBT Gate Driver

Rectifier

Inverter
VSD Logic Board

Signal From Main Control Panel

PWM Signal

LD15158

Figure 2 - CHILLER CONTROL SYSTEM

An integral liquid cooled, transistorized, PWM, Variable Speed Drive (VSD) is controlled by the chiller
microprocessor control panel to start/stop, select compressors to run, and select compressor speed. Displacement Power Factor is 0. 95 at part or full load.
The chiller microprocessor communicates with the
VSD Logic Board via a 3-wire RS-485 opto coupled
data link. The VSD Logic Board runs the number of
compressors required to meet the load and the compressors to the speed requested by the chiller microprocessor.
14

The basic system control and VSD system architecture is shown in Figure 2.
SEMI-HERMETIC YORK TWIN-SCREW
COMPRESSORS
Compressors are direct drive, semi-hermetic, rotary
twin-screw type, including: muffler, temperature actuated off-cycle heater, IP55 terminal board and precision machined cast iron housing.
Reliable suction gas cooled, high efficiency, accessible hermetic compressor motor, full suction gas flow
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

through mesh screen filter, with inherent internal thermal overload protection and external current overload
on all three phases.
Continuous function, microprocessor controlled, Variable Speed Drive (VSD) shall provide valve-less,
smooth capacity control from 100% down to 10% of
chiller capacity.
In addition, elimination of the slide valve and associated unloading components has resulted in a 50% reduction in compressor moving parts.
EVAPORATOR
The evaporator is a shell and tube, hybrid falling film
type heat exchanger. It contains a balance of flooded
and falling film technology to optimize efficiency, minimize refrigerant charge, and maintain reliable control.
A specifically designed distribution system provides
uniform refrigerant flow for optimum performance.
CONDENSER
The YVAA introduces micro-channel coil to the York
screw compressor chiller line. The micro-channel maximizes condenser heat transfer, resulting in a smaller
footprint, and reduces refrigerant charge by as much
as 50%.
Each condenser coil is a single piece all aluminum
construction including headers, tubes and fins to avoid
galvanic corrosion due to dissimilar metals. Coils and
headers are brazed as one piece. Integral sub-cooling is
included. The design working pressure is 43 bar.
Multiple, standard low sound, high efficiency, TEAO
motor driven fans move air through the coils. They are
dynamically and statically balanced, direct drive with
corrosion-resistant glass fiber reinforced composite
blades molded into low-noise, full airfoil cross sections, providing vertical air discharge from extended
orifices for efficiency and low sound.
Fan motors are Totally Enclosed Air-Over (TEAO),
squirrel-cage type and current protected. The direct
drive motors feature double-sealed and permanently
lubricated ball bearings, cutting down on maintenance
cost over the life of the unit.
REFRIGERANT CIRCUIT
An independent refrigerant circuit is provided per
compressor. Each circuit uses copper refrigerant pipe
formed on computer controlled bending machines to

JOHNSON CONTROLS

SECTION 2 - PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

reduce the number of brazed joints resulting in a reliable and leak resistant system.
Discharge lines are provided with a manual compressor shutoff service valve (See Accessories
and Options on Page 17 for suction line service
valve).
The external oil separators, with no moving parts
and designed for minimum oil carry-over, are
mounted in the discharge line of the compressor.
Liquid line components include: high absorption removable core filter-drier, sight glasses with
moisture indicators, manual shut-off valve with
charging port, orifice and electronic expansion
valve.
An economizer (flash) tank is located in each refrigerant circuit to increase the system efficiency.
ELECTRICAL
YORK has over 25 years of experience designing variable -speed drives specifically for chiller applications.
The result is an extremely reliable air-cooled chiller
system that offers industry leading efficiency at real
world operating conditions, valve-less compressor
loading/unloading, excellent capacity control, high
power factor and soft start..
Incoming single point power is standard utilizing a
lockable circuit breaker, 115VACcontrol transformer,
VSD, fan contactors, ON/OFF unit switch, microcomputer keypad and display, Chiller Control and VSD
Logic boards, and relay boards.
Standard design includes IP55 rating, powder painted
steel cabinet with hinged, latched, and gasket sealed
outer doors equipped with wind struts for safer servicing. The panel includes a control display access door so
that display and control features can be accessed without opening main cabinet doors.
All exposed power wiring is routed through liquidtight, UV-stabilized, non-metallic conduit.
BUILDING AUTOMATION SYSTEM
CAPABILITIES
The E-Link Gateway provides an economical and versatile connection between York equipment and open/
standard protocols. It efficiently manages the communication protocols currently used by York equipment,
exposing the data in a consistent, organized, and defined fashion. The E-Link Gateway is available as a
field-installed option on YVAA. A simple switch se15

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 2 - PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

lection allows configuration of the required equipment


profile and output protocol, which reduces equipment
connectivity startup time.
MICROCOMPUTER CONTROL CENTER
The microcomputer control center (see Figure 3 on
Page 16) provides automatic control of chiller operation including compressor start/ stop and load/
unload anti-recycle timers, condenser fans, evaporator pump, evaporator heater, unit alarm contacts and
run signal contacts. The microcomputer control center
comes online as soon as the main power switch on the
unit is switched on; immediately, the microcomputer
control center will begin to check all variables with a
frequency ranging from 30 seconds to almost continuous monitoring.
The microprocessor controls the units capacity by
matching the actual leaving chilled water temperature (LCWT) to the user-defined setpoint. Factors that
may cause the systems actual LCWT to fluctuate are
changes in ambient temperature, loop flow rate, load,
and loop volume. The control system reacts to such
changes by adjusting the number of compressors that
are on and the loading of each compressor in order to
keep the LCWT at the setpoint.

Programmable Setpoints
Chiller On/Off
Chilled Liquid (Water or Glycol)
Local or Remote Control
Units of Measure (Imperial or SI)
System Lead / Lag
Remote Temperature Reset
Remote Current Limit
Leaving Chilled Liquid Temperature Setpoint and
Range
Johnson Controls systems or another vendors systems
can incorporate these setpoints and data outputs to give
the customer a complete understanding of how the system is running through a Building Automation System.
Extreme Conditions - During extreme or unusual conditions (i.e. blocked condenser coils, ambient above
scheduled maximum, etc.) the chiller control system
will avoid shutdown by varying capacity. By monitoring motor current and suction and discharge pressures,
the chiller can maintain maximum available cooling
output without shutting down.

The control system logic monitors the rate at which the


LCWT is approaching the setpoint to ramp up or down
compressor capacity as required. The variable frequency drive allows the compressor capacity to match the
load.
Display Data
Leaving Chilled Liquid Temperature
Returning Liquid Temperature
Ambient Temperature
Lead System
Compressor Capacity (% of Full Load Amps)
VSD Output Frequency / Compressor Speed
Compressor Run Hours
Compressor Number of Starts
Oil Pressure and Temperature (per Compressor)
Evaporator Pump Status
Evaporator Heater Status
History Data for Last Twenty Normal Shutdowns
History Data for Last Ten Shutdown Faults

16

Figure 3 - VIEW OF YORK CONTROL CENTER


USER INTERFACE
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

Unit Safeties are provided for the chiller to perform


auto-reset shut down for the following conditions:
Ambient temperature above or below allowable
range
Out of range leaving chilled liquid temperature
Under voltage
Flow switch operation
ACCESSORIES AND OPTIONS
All options factory mounted unless otherwise noted.
SOUND ATTENUATION
Low Noise Kits The standard chiller configuration is
equipped with low sound fans and acoustic treatments
on the refrigerant lines and compressors. There are
several sound attenuation options available to further
reduce sound at its source thereby meeting local sound
level regulations.
SilentNight - Due to time of day based sound regulations in some locations it may be desirable to force the
chiller to a lower sound level on demand. The SilentNight control option provides a control input to limit
sound output of the chiller based on time of day. This
feature is programmable at the chiller panel or can be
controlled remotely via a signal (4-20mA or 0-10VDC)
from a BAS system.
FAN OPTIONS
Ultra Quiet Fans The chiller is equipped with specially designed fans and motors to provide lower sound
levels yet retain appropriate airflow. The result is reduced fan generated sound with minimal effect on the
chiller capacity or efficiency.
High Static Fans - The chiller is equipped with condenser fans with higher power motors suitable for high
external static pressure, up to 100 Pa (0.4 in. water),
across condenser coils. This option should be selected
if additional airflow resistance may be present due to
flow restrictions such as field installed ducts, filters,
sound enclosures etc. Please contact your local JCI
representative for more information.
High Airflow Fans - The chiller is equipped with condenser fans with airfoil type blades and high power motors providing extra airflow across coils. In some chiller
configurations, this option can provide an increase in
chiller capacity at high ambient. The high airflow fans are
also available with variable speed control. Please contact
your local JCI representative for more information.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

SECTION 2 - PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

CONDENSER COIL PROTECTION


The aluminum alloys used in the YVAA micro-channel condenser have been carefully selected and tested
for high corrosion resistance. However, all metals can
corrode in harsh conditions. Consider protecting coils
from corrosive environments such as coastal, marine,
urban and industrial.
Post-Coated Epoxy Dipped Condenser - Microchannel condenser coils applied with electro-deposited
and baked flexible epoxy coating that is finished with a
polyurethane UV resistant top-coat suitable for highly
corrosive applications.
PROTECTIVE CHILLER PANELS
Wire Panels UV stabilized black polyvinyl chloride
coated, heavy gauge, welded wire mesh guards mounted
on the exterior of the full unit. Protects condenser coil
faces and prevents unauthorized access to refrigerant
components (compressors, pipes, evaporator, etc.), yet
provides free air flow. This can cut installation cost by
eliminating the need for separate, expensive fencing.
Louvered Panels Louvered panels, painted the same
color as the unit, enclose the unit to visually screen
and protect the coils as well as preventing unauthorized access to internal components. Also available as a
condenser-only option.
Louvered/Wire Panels Combination - Louvered panels, painted the same color as the unit, are mounted on
external condenser coil faces. Heavy gauge, welded
wire-mesh panels, coated to resist corrosion, are mounted
around base of machine to restrict unauthorized access.
End Hail Guard Louvered panels, painted the same
color as the unit, are installed on the rear of the unit
(opposite end of the control panel) to protect the exposed condenser from flying debris or hail.
V-Guard Panels Solid panels, painted the same color as the unit, are installed along the sides of the units
to cover exposed piping within the condenser section
without impacting airflow. These guard panels can be
combined with End Hail Guard option for additional
protection from debris.
EVAPORATOR OPTIONS
38 mm insulation Double thickness insulation provided.
Flange Kit Provides contractor with the couplings
best suited to tie into the chilled water piping. All
flanges are PN10.
17

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 2 - PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

Connection Location - The standard unit configuration is available with fluid inlet connections at rear (opposite control panel end) of unit. Option available for
front fluid inlet on select configurations.
Water Box Heater - The standard unit comes with
freeze protection on the evaporator down to -17.8C
(0F).The waterbox heater option provides additional
freeze protection down to -28C(-20F).
CONTROLS OPTIONS
High Ambient Operation This provides special
control logic coupled with high airflow fans to permit
high ambient up to 52C (125F) operation. Fans are
airfoil type blades with high power motors. This option
may also allow for increased machine capacity, allowing the selection of a smaller chassis to meet specific
capacity requirements.
Building Automation System Interface (Temperature) - Factory installed option to accept a 4 to 20mA
or a 0 to 10VDC input to allow remote reset of the
Leaving Chilled Liquid Temperature Setpoint. The
setpoint can be positively offset upwards up to 22.2C
(40F). This option is useful for ice storage or process
applications or for periods where higher chilled liquid
temperatures are adequate for low loads. Available
alone or in combination with BAS Load Limit.

ing in horizontal pipe. This flow switch or equivalent must


be furnished with each unit. Field mounted.
Differential Pressure Switch This 0.2-3 barg (3-45
psig) range switch, with 1/4" NPTE pressure connections, is an alternative to the paddle-type flow switch.
Field mounted.
Service Isolation Valve Service suction isolation
valve added to unit for each refrigerant circuit.

Dual Pressure Relief Valve Two safety relief valves


are mounted in parallel; one is always operational to
assist in valve replacement during maintenance.
Terminal Block [not available for CE marked units]
Terminal Block connections shall be provided at

the point of incoming single point connection for


field connection and interconnecting wiring to the
compressors. Separate external protection must be
supplied, by others, in the incoming power wiring,
which must comply with local codes.
Circuit Breaker A unit-mounted circuit breaker with
external lockable handle will be supplied to isolate the
single point power voltage for servicing. The circuit
breaker is sized to provide motor branch circuit protection, short circuit protection and ground fault protection for the motor branch-circuit conductors, the motor
control apparatus and the motors.

Building Automation System Interface (Load Limit) - Factory installed option to accept a 4 to 20mA or
a 0 to 10VDC input to allow remote reset of the Load
Limit Setpoint. The setpoint can limit system demand
from 30-100%. Available alone or in combination with
BAS Temperature Reset.

Non-Fused Disconnect Switch Unit-mounted disconnect switch with external lockable handle can be
supplied to isolate the unit power voltage for servicing.
Separate external fusing must be supplied by the power
wiring, which must comply with local codes.

E-Link The optional E-Link gateway provides communication between the equipment and Building Automation Systems, including BACnet (MS/TP), Modbus,
LON and N2.

VIBRATION ISOLATION

Thermal Storage Provides special control logic and


modifications to produce leaving chilled brine temperatures below 4.4C (40F) primarily at times of low
ambient temperatures (night time). Option can be used
to produce ice to supplement cooling and significantly
decrease energy costs. The capability of the chiller is
enhanced by using both ice and chilled water simultaneously during times of peak cooling needs.
GENERAL OPTIONS
Flow Switch Accessory - Vapor proof SPDT, NEMA 3R
switch, 10.3 barg (150 psig) DWP, -29C to 121C (-20F
to 250F) with 1" NPT (IPS) connection for upright mount18

Elastomeric Isolation This option is recommended


for normal installations. It provides very good performance in most applications for the least cost. Field
mounted.
25 mm (1") Spring Isolators Spring and cage type
isolators for mounting under the unit base rails are
available to support unit. They are level adjustable. 25
mm (1") nominal deflection may vary slightly by applic ation. Field mounted.
50 mm (2") Restrained Spring Isolators Restrained
Spring-Flex Mounting isolators incorporate a rugged
welded steel housing with vertical and horizontal limit
stops. Housings designed to withstand a minimum 1.0g
accelerated force in all directions up to 51 mm (2").
The deflection may vary slightly by application. They
are level adjustable. Field mounted.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 3 - HANDLING AND STORAGE


DELIVERY AND STORAGE

MOVING THE CHILLER

To ensure consistent quality and maximum reliability,


all units are tested and inspected before leaving the factory. Units are shipped completely assembled and containing refrigerant under pressure. Units are shipped
without export crating unless crating has been specified on the Sales Order.

Prior to moving the unit, ensure that the installation


site is suitable for installing the unit and is easily capable of supporting the weight of the unit and all associated services.

If the unit is to be put into storage, prior to installation,


the following precautions should be observed:
The chiller must be blocked so that the base is
not permitted to sag or bow.
Ensure that all openings, such as water connections, are securely capped.
Do not store where exposed to ambient air temperatures exceeding 43C (110F).
The condensers should be covered to protect the
coils and fins from potential damage and corrosion,
particularly where building work is in progress.
The unit should be stored in a location where there
is minimal activity in order to limit the risk of accidental physical damage.
To prevent inadvertent operation of the pressure
relief devices the unit must not be steam cleaned.
It is recommended that the unit is periodically inspected during storage.

The units are designed to be lifted using shackles or


safety hooks. A spreader bar or frame should be used
in order to prevent damage to the unit from the lifting
chains. (Refer to Figure 4 on Page 20 for hooks.)
Units are provided with lifting eyes in the sides of the
base frame, which can be attached directly using container lugs, shackles or safety hooks (see Figure 4 on
Page 20 for proper lifting illustration).
The unit must only be lifted by the base
frame at the points provided. Never move
the unit on rollers, or lift the unit using a
forklift truck.
Care should be taken to avoid damaging the condenser
cooling fins when moving the unit.
LIFTING WEIGHTS
For details of weights and weight distribution, refer to
the data shipped in the chiller information packet and
unit nameplate.

INSPECTION
Remove any transit packing and inspect the unit to ensure that all components have been delivered and that
no damage has occurred during transit. If any damage
is evident, it should be noted on the carriers freight bill
and a claim entered in accordance with the instructions
given on the advice note.
Major damage must be reported immediately to your
local Johnson Controls representative.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

19

SECTION 3 - HANDLING AND STORAGE

LIFTING UNIT
Container lugs should be inserted into the holes provided in the bottom of the frame rail.
Use spreader bars to avoid lifting chains hitting the
chiller. Various methods of spreader bar arrangements
may be used; keeping in mind the intent is to keep the
unit stable and to keep the chains from hitting the chiller and causing damage.

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

Never lift the chiller using a forklift or by


hooking to the top rails. Use only the lifting holes provided.

Lifting instructions are placed on a label on the chiller


and on the shipping bag.

Figure 4 - PROPER LIFTING OF YVAA CHILLER


20

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 3 - HANDLING AND STORAGE

UNIT REMOVAL FROM SHIPPING


CONTAINER
1. Place a clevis pin into the holes provided at the
end of each base rail on the unit. Attach chains or
nylon straps through the clevis pins and hook onto
a suitable lift truck for pulling the unit out of the
container.(chain shown)

2. Slowly place tension on the chains or straps until


the unit begins to move and then slowly pull the
unit from the container. Be sure to pull straight so
the sides do not scrape the container.
3. Place a lifting fixture on the forks of the lift truck
and reattach the chain or strap. Slightly lift the
front of the unit to remove some weight from the
floor of the container. Continue pulling the unit
with an operator on each side to guide the lift
truck operator.
4. Pull the unit until the lifting locations are outside
of the container. Place 4 X 4 blocks of wood under
the base rails of the unit. Gently rest the unit on
the blocks and remove the chains and lift truck.
5. Attach lifting rigging from the crane and slowly
complete the removal from the container then lift
up and away.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

21

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 3 - HANDLING AND STORAGE

LIFTING USING LUGS


Units are provided with lifting holes in the base frame
which accept the accessory lifting lug set as shown in
the figure below. The lugs (RH and LH) should be inserted into the respective holes in the base frame and
turned so that the spring loaded pin engages into the
hole and the flanges on the lug lock behind the hole.
The lugs should be attached to the cables/chains using
shackles or safety hooks.
CORRECT

Lifting Instructions are placed on a label on the chiller


and on the shipping bag.

INCORRECT
LUG

LIFTING HOLE
IN BASE FRAME

LUG

Never lift the chiller using a forklift or by


hooking to the top rails. Use only the lifting holes provided.

FLANGE

FLANGE
LOCKING PIN
LIFTING HOLE
IN BASE FRAME

LOCKING PIN

LUG

LOCKING
PIN
FLANGE

LIFTING USING SHACKLES


The shackles should be inserted into the respective
holes in the base frame and secured from the inside.

36 mm

67 mm

Use spreader bars to avoid lifting chains hitting the


chiller. Various methods of spreader bar arrangements
may be used, keeping in mind the intent is to keep the
unit stable and to keep the chains from hitting the chiller and causing damage..
22

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION
LOCATION REQUIREMENTS

LOCATION CLEARANCES

For optimum performance and trouble-free service, it


is essential that the installation site meet the location
and space requirements for the model being installed.

Adequate clearances around the unit(s) are required for


the unrestricted airflow for the air-cooled condenser
coils and to prevent re-circulation of warm discharge
air back onto the coils. If clearances given are not
maintained, airflow restriction or re-circulation will
cause a loss of unit performance, an increase in power
consumption, and may cause the unit to malfunction.
Consideration should also be given to the possibility of
down drafts, caused by adjacent buildings, which may
cause re-circulation or uneven unit airflow.

It is important to ensure that the minimum service access space is maintained for cleaning and maintenance
purposes.
OUTDOOR INSTALLATIONS
The units are designed for outdoor installation and
can be installed at ground level on a suitable flat level
foundation easily capable of supporting the weight of
the unit, or on a suitable rooftop location. In both cases
an adequate supply of air is required. Avoid locations
where the sound output and air discharge from the unit
may be objectionable.
The location should be selected for minimum sun exposure and away from boiler flues and other sources
of airborne chemicals that could attack the condenser
coils and steel parts of the unit.
If located in an area accessible to unauthorized persons, steps must be taken to prevent access to the unit
by means of a protective fence. This will help to prevent the possibility of vandalism, accidental damage,
or possible harm caused by unauthorized removal of
protective guards or opening panels to expose rotating
or high voltage components.
For ground level locations, the unit must be installed
on a suitable flat and level concrete base that extends
to fully support the two side channels of the unit base
frame. A one-piece concrete slab, with footings extending below the frost line is recommended. To avoid
noise and vibration transmission, the unit should not be
secured to the building foundation.

For locations where significant cross winds are expected, such as exposed roof tops, an enclosure of solid
or louver type is recommended to prevent wind turbulence interfering with the unit airflow.
When units are installed in an enclosure, the enclosure
height should not exceed the height of the unit on more
than one side. If the enclosure is of louvered construction, the same requirement of static pressure loss applies as for ducts and attenuators stated above.
Recommended Minimum Clearances
Recommended clearances for the YVAA units are:
Side to wall 6' (1.8 m)
Rear to wall 6' (1.8 m)
Control panel end to wall 4' (1.2 m)
Top no obstructions whatsoever
Distance between adjacent units 10' (3 m)

On rooftop locations, choose a place with adequate


structural strength to safely support the entire operating
weight of the unit and service personnel. The unit can
be mounted on a concrete slab, similar to ground floor
locations, or on steel channels of suitable strength. The
channels should be spaced with the same centers as the
unit side and front base rails. This will allow vibration
isolators to be fitted if required. Isolators are recommended for rooftop locations.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

23

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

Tube Removal
Clearance Area

1.8 m (6')
Minimum

Tube Removal
Clearance Area

3 m (10')
Minimum

Clearance dimensions provided in Figure


5 are necessary to maintain good airflow
and ensure correct unit operation. It is
also necessary to consider access requirements for safe operation and maintenance of the unit and power and control
panels. Local health and safety regulations, or practical considerations for
service replacement of large components,
may require larger clearances than those
recommended.
VIBRATION ISOLATORS

1.2 m (4')
Minimum

Control Panel

Figure 5 - ACCEPTABLE MINIMUM CLEARANCES


AROUND/BETWEEN UNIT(S)
Table 1 - MINIMUM EVAPORATOR TUBE REMOVAL CLEARANCE
TUBE REMOVAL
CLEARANCE DIMENSIONS
A
B
C
FRAME EVAP COND IN. MM IN. MM IN. MM
015
3
B
26 663 36 914 132 3353
016
5
B
26 663 36 914 132 3353
017
8
C
26 663 36 914 156 3962
018
3
A
26 663 36 914 144 3658
019
5
A
26 663 36 914 144 3658
019
8
B
26 663 36 914 132 3353
020
0
C
26 663 36 914 156 3962
021
3
A
26 663 36 914 144 3658
021
5
C
26 663 36 914 156 3962
021
8
C
26 663 36 914 156 3962
023
3
B
26 663 36 914 132 3353
024
5
C
26 663 36 914 156 3962
024
8
C
26 663 36 914 156 3962
026
3
B
26 663 36 914 132 3353
027
3
D
26 663 36 914 192 4877
027
5
E
26 663 36 914 192 4877
027
8
E
26 663 36 914 192 4877
029
5
E
26 663 36 914 192 4877
030
3
C
26 663 36 914 156 3962
030
5
C
26 663 36 914 156 3962
030
8
E
26 663 36 914 192 4877
031
8
E
26 663 36 914 192 4877
032
3
E
26 663 36 914 192 4877
033
3
C
26 663 36 914 156 3962
034
3
E
26 663 36 914 192 4877
034
5
E
26 663 36 914 192 4877
050
0
J
26 663 36 914 192 4877
052
3
J
26 663 36 914 192 4877
MODEL YVAA

24

Optional sets of vibration isolators can be supplied


loose with each unit.
Using the Isolator tables shipped with the unit in the
information pack. Identify each mount and its correct
location on the unit.
Installation
Place each mount in its correct position and lower the
unit carefully onto the mounts ensuring the mount engages in the mounting holes in the unit base frame.
On adjustable mounts, transfer the unit weight evenly
to the springs by turning the mount adjusting nuts (located just below the top plate of the mount) counterclockwise to raise and clockwise to lower. This should
be done two turns at a time until the top plates of all
mounts are between 1/4" (6 mm) and 1/2" (12 mm)
clear of top of their housing and the unit base is level.
SHIPPING BRACES
The chillers modular design does not require shipping
braces.
CHILLED LIQUID PIPING
General Requirements
The following piping recommendations are intended to
ensure satisfactory operation of the unit(s). Failure to
follow these recommendations could cause damage to
the unit, or loss of performance, and may invalidate the
warranty.
The maximum flow rate and pressure
drop for the evaporator must not be exceeded at any time. Refer to SECTION 5
- TECHNICAL DATA on Page 49 for
details.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

The liquid must enter the evaporator at


the inlet connection. The standard inlet
connection for the evaporator is opposite
the control panel end of the evaporator.
A flow switch must be installed in the
customer piping at the outlet of the evaporator and wired back to the control panel
using shielded cable.
There should be a straight run of piping of at least 5
pipe diameters on either side. The flow switch should
be wired to Terminals 2 and 13 on the 1TB terminal
block. A flow switch is required to prevent damage to
the evaporator caused by the unit operating without adequate liquid flow.
The flow switch used must have gold plated contacts
for low voltage/current operation. Paddle type flow
switches suitable for 10 bar (150 PSIG) working pressure and having a 1" N.P.T. connection can be obtained
from Johnson Controls as an accessory for the unit. Alternatively, a differential pressure switch fitted across
an orifice plate may be used, preferably of the high/low
limit type.
The chilled liquid pump(s) installed in the piping
system(s) should discharge directly into the unit evaporator section of the system. The pump(s) may be controlled
by the chiller controls or external to the unit.
Pipework and fittings must be separately supported to
prevent any loading on the evaporator. Flexible connections are recommended which will also minimize
transmission of vibrations to the building. Flexible
connections must be used if the unit is mounted on
anti-vibration mounts, as some movement of the unit
can be expected in normal operation.
Piping and fittings immediately next to the evaporator
should be readily de-mountable to enable cleaning before operation, and to facilitate visual inspection of the
exchanger nozzles.
The evaporator must be protected by a
strainer, preferably of 40 mesh, fitted as
close as possible to the liquid inlet connection, and provided with a means of local
isolation.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

The evaporator must not be exposed to flushing velocities or debris released during flushing. It is recommended that a suitably sized bypass and valve arrangement is installed to allow flushing of the piping system.
The bypass can be used during maintenance to isolate
the heat exchanger without disrupting flow to other
units.
Thermometer and pressure gauge connections should
be provided on the inlet and outlet connections of each
evaporator. Gauges and thermometers are not provided
with the unit and are to be furnished by others.
Drain and air vent connections should be provided at
all low and high points in the piping to permit drainage
of the system and to vent any air in the pipes.
Liquid system lines at risk of freezing, due to low ambient temperatures should be protected using insulation and heater tape and/or a suitable glycol solution.
The liquid pump(s) may also be used to ensure liquid
is circulated when the ambient temperature approaches
freezing point.
Insulation should also be installed around the evaporator nozzles. Heater tape of 21 Watts per meter under
the insulation is recommended, supplied independently
and controlled by an ambient temperature thermostat
set to switch ON at approximately 2.2C (4F), above
the freezing temperature of the chilled liquid.
The evaporator is protected by heater mats placed under the insulation, which are powered from the unit
control system power supply. During cold weather
when there is a risk of freezing, chiller power should be
left switched on to provide the freeze protection function unless the liquid systems have been drained.
Any debris left in the water piping between the strainer and evaporator could
cause serious damage to the tubes in the
evaporator and must be avoided. Be sure
the piping is clean before connecting it to
the evaporator. Keep evaporator nozzles
and chilled liquid piping capped prior to
installation to assure construction debris
is not allowed to enter.
The installer/user must also ensure that
the quality of the water in circulation is
adequate, without any dissolved gases,
which can cause oxidation of steel or
copper parts within the evaporator.

25

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

WATER TREATMENT
The unit performance provided in the Design Guide
is based on a fouling factor of 0.018m2/hr C/kW
(0.0001 ft2hrF/Btu). Dirt, scale, grease and certain
types of water treatment will adversely affect the heat
exchanger surfaces and therefore the unit performance.
Foreign matter in the water system(s) can increase the
heat exchanger pressure drop, reducing the flow rate
and causing potential damage to the heat exchanger
tubes.
Aerated, brackish or salt water is not recommended for
use in the water system(s). Johnson Controls recommends that a water treatment specialist should be consulted to determine whether the proposed water composition will adversely affect the evaporator materials
of carbon steel and copper. The pH value of the water
flowing through the evaporator must be kept in a range
between 7 and 8.5.

For air conditioning applications, a minimum of 3 gallons/ton is required. It is preferred that the gallon/ton
ratio be within the 5 to 8 range. For process applications, a minimum of 6 gallons/ton ratio is required with
preference towards a range of 7 to 11. Install a tank or
increase pipe sizes to provide sufficient water volume.
LEAVING WATER TEMPERATURE OUT OF
RANGE
The YVAA chiller line has a maximum leaving
water temperature of 15.6C (60F). Where process
applications require a chilled water temperature higher
than what the chiller provides, a simple piping change
can remove the problem. By using a mixture of chillercooled water and returning process water, the chilled
water entering the process can be held at the desired
temperature. A tank can also be used to meet high leaving water temperature requirements.

PIPEWORK ARRANGEMENT
The following is a suggested piping arrangement for
single unit installations.

RECIRCULATION
SUPPLY TO LOAD
RETURN FROM LOAD
-Isolating Valve - Normally Open
-Isolating Valve - Normally Closed
-Flow Regulating Valve
-Flow Measurement Device

LOAD

Figure 7 - L
 EAVING WATER TEMPERATURE OUT
OF RANGE SUGGESTED LAYOUT

-Strainer
-Pressure Tapping
-Flow Switch
-Flanged Connection
-Pipework

FLOW RATE OUT OF RANGE


LD15151

Figure 6 - PIPEWORK ARRANGEMENT

MINIMUM WATER VOLUME


It is good practice to include as much water volume
as possible in a chilled water loop. This increases the
thermal mass and Flywheel effect within the system
(i.e. the more; the better) which in turn promotes stable
water temperature control and increases reliability by
reducing compressor cycling.

26

LD15049

Each YVAA evaporator has a minimum and maximum


flow rate. Some process applications require a flow
rate that is out of range for the evaporator. In those applications, a piping change can remove the problem.
In applications where the required flow rate is less than
the evaporators minimum allowable, the chilled water
can be recirculated to the chiller.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

when it is needed which is commonly during times of


peak demand. Thermal storage allows generation of
cooling capacity to occur during off-peak periods and
store that capacity to meet future cooling requirements.
Using thermal storage can result in smaller equipment
sizes, thereby reducing capital cost, and also can result
in significant energy cost savings
BYPASS
SUPPLY TO LOAD
RETURN FROM LOAD

LOAD

LD15049

Figure 8 - SUGGESTED LAYOUT FOR APPLICATIONS WITH A FLOW RATE LESS THAN
THE EVAPORATOR MINIMUM ALLOWABLE FLOW RATE

In applications where the required flow rate is greater


than the evaporators maximum allowable, the chilled
water can be recirculated to the load.

The YVAA has special control logic to be able to produce chilled leaving brine temperatures below 4.4C
(40F) so as to supply a storage tank with chilled liquid
during times of low demand. YVAA chillers selected
for thermal storage operation can also be selected to efficiently provide chilled fluid at nominal cooling loads.
VARIABLE PRIMARY FLOW
Johnson Controls recommends a maximum 10% per
minute flow rate of change, based on design flow, for
variable primary flow applications. Provide 8 to 10 gallons per chiller ton (8.6 to 10.8 liter per cooling KW)
system water volume. Insufficient system volume and
rapid flow changes can cause control problems or can
even cause chiller shutdowns. There are many other
design issues to evaluate with variable primary flow
systems. Consult your Johnson Controls Sales Office for more information about successfully applying
YVAA chillers.
CONNECTION TYPES AND SIZES
For connection sizes relevant to individual models refer to SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA.

BYPASS

EVAPORATOR CONNECTIONS

SUPPLY TO LOAD
RETURN FROM LOAD

LOAD

LD15049

Standard chilled liquid connections on evaporators


are of the Victaulic Groove type for ASME and PED
marked units and Flange type for GB marked units (see
Figure 11 on page 28 for flange dimensions on GB
marked vessels).

Figure 9 - SUGGESTED LAYOUT FOR APPLICATIONS WITH A FLOW RATE LESS THAN
THE EVAPORATOR MINIMUM ALLOWABLE FLOW RATE

THERMAL STORAGE
Thermal storage is the practice of storing cooling energy during a period of little or no load and/or low energy
costs for use during periods of high load and/or energy
costs. Conventional cooling systems produce cooling

JOHNSON CONTROLS

LD10494

Figure 10 - VICTAULIC GROOVE

27

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

Table 2 - EVAPORATOR CONNECTIONS DIMENSIONS


VICTAULIC
NOMINAL
CONNECTIONS
DIAMETER
SIZE

FLANGE DIMENSONS (GB ONLY) IN MM*


B

QUANTITY

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

021

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

023

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

024

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

024

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

026

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

027

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

027

8"

DN200

221.5

27

345

298.5

22

270

027

8"

DN200

221.5

27

345

298.5

22

270

029

8"

DN200

221.5

27

345

298.5

22

270

030

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

030

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

030

8"

DN200

221.5

27

345

298.5

22

270

031

8"

DN200

221.5

27

345

298.5

22

270

032

8"

DN200

221.5

27

345

298.5

22

270

033

6"

DN150

170.5

27

280

241.5

22

216

034

8"

DN200

221.5

27

345

298.5

22

270

034

8"

DN200

221.5

27

345

298.5

22

270

050

8"

DN200

221.5

27

345

298.5

22

270

052

8"

DN200

221.5

27

345

298.5

22

270

FRAME

COND.

EVAP.

015

6"

016

017

018

019

019
020
021
021

* Reference Figure 34 for flange dimensions.

n-L

n-L

4" / 6" / 8" FLANGE

D
d

D
d

10" FLANGE

C
LD16185a

Figure 11 - FLANGE FOR GB VESSELS

28

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

Option Flanges
One of two types of flanges may be fitted depending
on the customer or local pressure vessel code requirements. These are Victaulic-Adapter flanges, normally
supplied loose, or weld flanges, which may be supplied loose or ready-fitted. Victaulic-Adapter and weld
flange dimensions are to ISO 7005 - NP10.

If relief piping is common to more than one valve, its


cross-sectional area must be at least the total required
by each valve. Valve types should not be mixed on a
common pipe. Precautions should be taken to ensure
the outlets of relief valves or relief valve vent pipes
remain clear of obstructions at all times.
ELECTRICAL CONNECTION
The following connection recommendations are intended to ensure safe and satisfactory operation of the
unit. Failure to follow these recommendations could
cause harm to persons or damage the unit, and may
invalidate the warranty.

WELD FLANGE

VICTAULIC ADAPTER

LD10495

Figure 12 - FLANGE ATTACHMENT

REFRIGERANT RELIEF VALVE PIPING


The evaporator is protected against internal refrigerant
overpressure by refrigerant relief valves. A pressure relief valve is mounted on each of the main refrigerant
lines connecting the evaporator to the compressors.
A piece of pipe is fitted to each valve and directed so
that when the valve is activated the release of high
pressure gas and liquid cannot be a danger or cause
injury. For indoor installations (not recommended),
pressure relief valves should be piped to the exterior
of the building.
The size of any piping attached to a relief valve must
be of sufficient diameter so as not to cause resistance to
the operation of the valve. Unless otherwise specified
by local regulations. Internal diameter depends on the
length of pipe required and is given by the following
formula:
D5 = 1.447 x L
Where:
D = minimum pipe internal diameter in cm
L = length of pipe in meters

JOHNSON CONTROLS

No additional controls (relays, etc.)


should be mounted in the control panel.
Power and control wiring not connected
to the control panel should not be run
through the control panel. If these precautions are not followed it could lead to
a risk of electrocution. In addition, electrical noise could cause malfunctions or
damage the unit and its controls.
After power wiring connection, do not
switch on mains power to the unit. Some
internal components are live when the
mains are switched on and this must only
be done by Authorized persons familiar
with starting, operating, and troubleshooting this type of equipment.
POWER WIRING
All electrical wiring should be carried out in accordance with local regulations. Route properly sized
cables to cable entries on the unit.
In accordance with local codes, NEC codes, U.L. and
C.E. standards, it is the responsibility of the user to install over current protection devices between the supply conductors and the power supply terminals on the
unit.
To ensure that no eddy currents are set up in the power
panel, the cables forming the 3-phase power supply
must enter via the same cable entry.
All sources of supply to the unit must be
taken via a common point of isolation (not
supplied by Johnson Controls).

29

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

POWER SUPPLY WIRING

VOLTS FREE CONTACTS

Units require only one 3-phase supply, plus earth.

Chilled Liquid Pump Starter

Connect the 3-phase supplies to the circuit breaker located in the panel (See Electrical Lug Data in Table 3
on page 34 ).

Terminals 23 and 24 on 1TB close to start the chilled


liquid pump. This contact can be used as a master start/
stop for the pump in conjunction with the daily start/
stop schedule.

Connect a suitably sized earth wire to the PE terminal


in the panel.
115VAC CONTROL SUPPLY TRANSFORMER
A 3-wire high voltage to 115VAC supply transformer
is standard in the chiller. This transformer is mounted
in the cabinet and steps down the high voltage supply
to 115VAC to be used by the controls, VSD, Feed and
Drain Valve Controller, valves, solenoids, heaters, etc.
The high voltage for the transformer primary is taken
from the chiller input. Fusing is provided for the transformer.
Removing high voltage power to the
chiller will remove the 115VAC supply
voltage to the control panel circuitry and
the evaporator heater. In cold weather,
this could cause serious damage to the
chiller due to evaporator freeze-up. Do
not remove power unless alternate means
are taken to ensure operation of the
evaporator heater.
CONTROL WIRING
All control wiring utilizing contact closures to the control panel terminal block is nominal 115VAC and must
be run in shielded cable, with the shield grounded at
the panel end only, and run in water tight conduit. Run
shielded cable separately from mains cable to avoid
electrical noise pick-up. Use the control panel cable
entry to avoid the power cables.
Voltage free contacts connected to the panel must be
suitable for 115VAC10 ma (gold contacts recommended). If the voltage free contacts form part of a relay or
contactor, the coil of the device must be suppressed using
a standard R/C suppressor. The above precautions must
be taken to avoid electrical noise, which could cause a
malfunction or damage to the unit and its controls.

30

Run Contact
Terminals 21 and 22 on 1TB close to indicate that a
system is running.
Alarm Contacts
Each system has a single voltage-free contact, which
will operate to signal an alarm condition whenever any
system locks out, or there is a power failure. To obtain
system alarm signal, connect the alarm circuit to volt
free Terminals 25 & 26 (Sys 1), Terminals 27 and 28
(Sys 2) of 1TB.
SYSTEM INPUTS
Flow Switch
A chilled liquid flow switch of suitable type MUST be
connected between Terminals 2 and 13 of 1TB to provide protection against loss of liquid flow, which will
cause evaporator freeze-up if the chiller is permitted
to run. The flow switch circuitry is a 115VACcircuit.
Contacts must be rated for low current (5mA). Gold
contacts should be used.
Remote Run / Stop
A Remote Run/Stop input is available for each systems.
These inputs require a dry contact to start and stop the
system. System 1 remote dry contacts are connected
between Terminals 2 and 15 of 1TB and System 2 dry
contacts are connected between Terminals 2 and 16 of
1TB. If remote start/stop is not utilized, a jumper must
be paced across the terminals to allow the system to
run. The remote run/stop circuitry is a 115VACcircuit.
Contacts must be rated for low current (5mA). Gold
contacts should be used.
Remote Print
Closure of suitable contacts connected to Terminals 2
and 14 of 1TB will cause a hard copy printout of Operating Data/Fault History to be made if an optional printer
is connected to the RS-232 port. The remote print circuitry is a 115VACcircuit. Contacts must be rated for
low current (5mA). Gold contacts should be used.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

Optional Remote Setpoint Offset


Temperature

Optional Remote Setpoint Offset Sound


Limiting

A voltage signal connected to Terminals 17 and 18 of


1TB will provide a remote offset function of the chilled
liquid setpoint, if required.

A voltage signal connected to Terminals 40 and 41 of


1TB will provide remote setting of sound limit setpoint,
if required.

Optional Remote Setpoint Offset Current


A voltage signal connected to Terminals 19 and 20
of 1TB will provide a remote setting of current limit
setpoint, if required.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

31

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

POWER SUPPLY WIRING

UNIT MOUNTED CONNECTIONS

INVERTER 2

LINE
REACTOR
TERMINAL BLOCK
(Circuit Breaker - Opt.)
(Non-Fused Disconnect
Switch - Opt.)

UNIT CONTROLS
EVAPORATOR HEATER

FAN
CONTACTORS

GRD

INVERTER 1

STANDARD
CONTROL
TRANSFORMER

See Note 1

FIELD PROVIDED
UNIT POWER
SUPPLY

LD15893

Voltage Utilization Range


Minimum Circuit Ampacity (MCA),
Minimum/Maximum Fuse Size and
Minimum/Maximum Circuit Breaker size
varies on chillers based upon model and
options ordered. Consult YorkWorks or
the chiller data plate for electrical data
on a specific chiller.

RATED
VOLTAGE

UTILIZATION RANGE

200/60/3

180-220

230/60/3

208-254

380/60/3

342-402

460/60/3

414-508

575/60/3

520-635

400/50/3

360-440

Figure 13 - POWER WIRING - 2 COMPRESSOR CONNECTIONS


32

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

CUSTOMER CONTROL WIRING

CONTROL
BOARD

RELAY
BOARD
No. 1

SYS. No. 1
ALARM
CONTACTS

FLOW SWITCH (-SF)


PRINT (PNT)
SYS. No. 1 RUN PERM
SYS. No. 2 RUN PERM

RELAY
BOARD
No. 2
EVAP. PUMP
START
SIGNAL
SYS. No. 2
ALARM
CONTACTS

CHILLER
RUN

LEGEND
TERMINAL BLOCK FOR CUSTOMER CONNECTIONS
TERMINAL BLOCK FOR YORK CONNECTIONS
WIRING AND COMPONENTS BY YORK
OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
WIRING AND/OR COMPONENTS BY OTHERS

Figure 14 - CUSTOMER CONTROL CONNECTIONS


JOHNSON CONTROLS

33

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

Table 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA


STANDARD & ULTRA QUIET CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS
YVAA MODEL
FRAME

015

016

017

018

COND

EVAP

TERMINAL BLOCK

INPUT
VOLTS

INPUT
FREQ

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

380

60

400

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

575

60

200

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

#2/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

34

NON-FUSED
DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


HIGH AIRFLOW/HIGH STATIC CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS

TERMINAL BLOCK

YVAA MODEL

INPUT INPUT
FRAME COND EVAP VOLTS FREQ

015

016

017

018

WIRE
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

35

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


STANDARD & ULTRA QUIET CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS
YVAA MODEL
FRAME

019

019

020

021

COND

EVAP

TERMINAL BLOCK

INPUT
VOLTS

INPUT
FREQ

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

380

60

400

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

575

60

200

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

36

NON-FUSED
DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


HIGH AIRFLOW/HIGH STATIC CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS

TERMINAL BLOCK

YVAA MODEL

INPUT INPUT
FRAME COND EVAP VOLTS FREQ

019

019

020

021

WIRE
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

37

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


STANDARD & ULTRA QUIET CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS
YVAA MODEL
FRAME

021

021

023

024

COND

EVAP

TERMINAL BLOCK

INPUT
VOLTS

INPUT
FREQ

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

380

60

400

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

575

60

200

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

38

NON-FUSED
DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


HIGH AIRFLOW/HIGH STATIC CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS

TERMINAL BLOCK

YVAA MODEL

INPUT INPUT
FRAME COND EVAP VOLTS FREQ

021

021

023

024

WIRE
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

39

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


STANDARD & ULTRA QUIET CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS
YVAA MODEL
FRAME

024

026

027

027

COND

EVAP

TERMINAL BLOCK

INPUT
VOLTS

INPUT
FREQ

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

380

60

400

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

575

60

200

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

40

NON-FUSED
DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


HIGH AIRFLOW/HIGH STATIC CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS

TERMINAL BLOCK

YVAA MODEL

INPUT INPUT
FRAME COND EVAP VOLTS FREQ

024

026

027

027

WIRE
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

41

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


STANDARD & ULTRA QUIET CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS
YVAA MODEL
FRAME

027

029

030

030

COND

EVAP

TERMINAL BLOCK

INPUT
VOLTS

INPUT
FREQ

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

200

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

230

60

380

60

400

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

575

60

200

60

230

60

380

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

42

NON-FUSED
DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


HIGH AIRFLOW/HIGH STATIC CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS

TERMINAL BLOCK

YVAA MODEL

INPUT INPUT
FRAME COND EVAP VOLTS FREQ

027

029

030

030

WIRE
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

200

60

#1/0 - 700 kcmil

230

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

4/0 - 500
kcmil

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

43

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


STANDARD & ULTRA QUIET CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS
YVAA MODEL
FRAME

030

031

032

033

COND

EVAP

TERMINAL BLOCK

CIRCUIT
BREAKER

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

INPUT
VOLTS

INPUT
FREQ

200

60

230

60

380

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

44

NON-FUSED
DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


HIGH AIRFLOW/HIGH STATIC CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS

TERMINAL BLOCK

YVAA MODEL

INPUT INPUT
FRAME COND EVAP VOLTS FREQ

030

031

032

033

200

60

230

60

WIRE
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

LUG WIRE
RANGE

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

45

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


STANDARD & ULTRA QUIET CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS
YVAA MODEL
FRAME

034

034

050

052

COND

EVAP

TERMINAL BLOCK

CIRCUIT
BREAKER

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 500 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 400 kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 500 kcmil

#3/0 - 500
kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 500 kcmil

#3/0 - 500
kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#1 - 500 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#1 - 500 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 500 kcmil

#3/0 - 500
kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 500 kcmil

#3/0 - 500
kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#1 - 500 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#1 - 500
kcmil

#1 - 500 kcmil

INPUT
VOLTS

INPUT
FREQ

200

60

230

60

380

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

46

NON-FUSED
DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION

TABLE 3 - ELECTRICAL LUG DATA (CONT'D)


HIGH AIRFLOW/HIGH STATIC CONDENSER FANS
FIELD WIRING LUGS

TERMINAL BLOCK

YVAA MODEL

INPUT INPUT
FRAME COND EVAP VOLTS FREQ

034

034

050

052

200

60

230

60

WIRE
PER
PHASE

LUG WIRE
RANGE

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
WIRES
PER
PHASE

LUG
WIRE
RANGE

WIRES
PER
PHASE

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

LUG WIRE
RANGE

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

4*

#2 - 600 kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#4/0 - 500
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

575

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#2 - 600 kcmil

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

575

60

200

60

230

60

380

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

400

50

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

460

60

#2 - 600 kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

#3/0 - 400
kcmil

575

60

* Up to 4 wires per phase, consisting of 2 lugs per phase where each lug can accomodate 2 wires.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH

Electrical Data Charts 04 08 2011

47

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

NOMENCLATURE

YVAA 015 XXXX 46 AA


1

BASE PRODUCT TYPE


: York

FRAME SIZE

10

11

: Variable Speed
Screw

12

13

: Condenser code

: 200 / 3 / 60

: Evaporator code

: 230 / 3 / 60

: Compressor code
: Condenser fan & sound kit code

4
4
5
5

0
6
0
8

: 380 / 3 / 60
: 460 / 3 / 60
: 380-415 / 3 / 50
: 575 / 3 / 60

CONFIGURATION
#
#

: Air cooled

VOLTAGE

14

15

LEVEL / REFRIGERANT
: Development Level A

A
A

: Refrigerant R134a

Products are produced at a


facility whose qualitymanagement systems are
ISO9001 certified.

ASHRAE

JOHNSON CONTROLS

90.1

Compliant

49

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

Table 4 - PHYSICAL DATA

The data shown in this table is applicable to selected


typical configurations. Other configurations are available through our configuration/selection software.
UNIT FRAME

Please contact your nearest Johnson Controls Sales Office for the chiller configuration that best matches your
specific needs.

015

016

017

018

019

019

CONDENSER CODE

EVAPORATOR CODE

GENERAL UNIT DATA


Number of Independent Refrigerant Circuits


Refrigerant Charge, R-134a,


Ckt.-1/Ckt.-2, lbs (kg)

175/175
(80/80)

190/190
(86/86)

225/225
(102/102)

175/155
(80/70)

190/170
(86/78)

220/195
(100/89)

Oil Charge, Ckt.-1/Ckt.-2, gal (liters)

2.1/2.0
(8.0/7.7)

2.2/2.2
(8.5/8.5)

2.5/2.5
(9.3/9.3)

2.4/2.0
(9.2/7.7)

2.6/2.1
(9.7/8.0)

2.7/2.2
(10.4/8.5)

% Minimum Load

10%

Unit shipping weight, lbs (kg) 1

11518
(5224)

12084
(5481)

14668
(6653)

12019
(5452)

12781
(5797)

13776
(6248

Operating Weight, lbs (kg) 1

11979
(5434)

12546
(5691)

15432
(7000)

12460
(5652)

13222
(5997)

14237
(6458)

Chassis Dimensions - Length, Ft (mm)

203.3
(5163)

247.2
(6280)

291.2
(7397)

247.0
(6274)

291.2
(7397)

335.2
(8514)

Chassis Dimensions - Width, Ft (mm)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

Chassis Dimensions - Height, Ft (mm)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

6/4

7/5

8/6

48 (182)

58 (220)

COMPRESSORS, SEMI-HERMETIC SCREW


Qty per Chiller

CONDENSER FANS
Number Ckt-1/Ckt-2

4/4

5/5

6/6

Air on Condenser (Min/Max), F (C )

0/125 (4.4/15.6)

EVAPORATOR, SHELL AND TUBE HYBRID FALLING FILM 2


Water Volume, gal (liters)

58 (220)

58 (220)

71 (269)

L
 eaving Water Temperature
(Min/Max), F (C ) 3

48 (182)

40/60 (4.4/15.6)

M
 aximum Water Side Pressure,
psig (bar)

150 (10.3)

M
 aximum Refrigerant Side
Pressure, psig (bar)

235 (16.2)

Evap Drain Connection, in

3/4

NOTES:
1. Shipping and operating weights shown are for base unit; selected options may add weight to unit. Contact your nearest Johnson Controls
Sales office for weight data.
2. The evaporator is protected against freezing to 0F(-17.8C) with a standard heater.
3. For leaving liquid temperature below 40F(4.4C) or above 60F (15.6C), contact your nearest Johnson Controls Sales Office for application requirements.

50

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TABLE 4 - PHYSICAL DATA (CONT'D)


UNIT FRAME

020

021

021

021

023

024

CONDENSER CODE

EVAPORATOR CODE

GENERAL UNIT DATA


Number of Independent Refrigerant Circuits


Refrigerant Charge, R-134a,


Ckt.-1/Ckt.-2, lbs (kg)

205/205
(93/93)

175/175
(80/80)

225/225
(102/102)

240/240
(109/109)

210/190
(96/86)

250/225
(114/102)

Oil Charge, Ckt.-1/Ckt.-2, gal (liters)

2.6/2.6
(10.0/10.0)

2.5/2.5
(9.3/9.3)

2.8/2.8
(10.5/10.5)

2.9/2.9
(10.8/10.8)

2.7/2.6
(10.1/9.7)

2.9/2.8
(11.1/10.5)

Unit shipping weight, lbs (kg) 1

13392
(6074)

12859
(5833)

14915
(6765)

15677
(7111)

13288
(6027)

15873
(7200)

Operating Weight, lbs (kg) 1

14155
(6421)

13300
(6033)

15678
(7111)

16440
(7457)

13750
(6237)

16636
(7546)

Chassis Dimensions - Length, Ft (mm)

226.0
(5741)

291.2
(7397)

291.2
(7397)

335.2
(8514)

291.2
(7397)

335.2
(8514)

Chassis Dimensions - Width, Ft (mm)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

Chassis Dimensions - Height, Ft (mm)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

7/7

7/5

8/6

58 (220)

71 (269)

% Minimum Load

10%

COMPRESSORS, SEMI-HERMETIC SCREW


Qty per Chiller

CONDENSER FANS
Number Ckt-1/Ckt-2

4/4

6/6

Air on Condenser (Min/Max), F (C )

6/6

0/125 (-17.8/51.7)

EVAPORATOR, SHELL AND TUBE HYBRID FALLING FILM 2


Water Volume, gal (liters)

71 (269)

48 (182)

71 (269)

L
 eaving Water Temperature
(Min/Max), F (C ) 3

71 (269)

40/60 (4.4/15.6)

M
 aximum Water Side Pressure,
psig (bar)

150 (10.3)

M
 aximum Refrigerant Side
Pressure, psig (bar)

235 (16.2)

Evap Drain Connection, in

3/4

NOTES:
1. Shipping and operating weights shown are for base unit; selected options may add weight to unit. Contact your nearest Johnson Controls
Sales office for weight data.
2. The evaporator is protected against freezing to 0F(-17.8C) with a standard heater.
3. For leaving liquid temperature below 40F(4.4C) or above 60F (15.6C), contact your nearest Johnson Controls Sales Office for application requirements.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

51

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TABLE 4 - PHYSICAL DATA (CONT'D)


UNIT FRAME

024

026

027

027

027

029

CONDENSER CODE

EVAPORATOR CODE

GENERAL UNIT DATA


Number of Independent Refrigerant Circuits


Refrigerant Charge, R-134a,


Ckt.-1/Ckt.-2, lbs (kg)

250/250
(114/114)

210/210
(96/96)

265/265
(120/120)

265/265
(121/121)

270/270
(123/123)

310/265
(141/120)

Oil Charge, Ckt.-1/Ckt.-2, gal (liters)

2.9/2.9
(11.1/11.1)

2.7/2.7
(10.1/10.1)

3.0/3.0
(11.4/11.4)

3.0/3.0
(11.4/11.4)

3.1/3.1
(11.6/11.6)

4.2/3.1
(15.9/11.7)

Unit shipping weight, lbs (kg) 1

16634
(7545)

14076
(6385)

16275
(7382)

16991
(7707)

17753
(8052)

18205
(8258)

Operating Weight, lbs (kg) 1

17398
(7891)

14538
(6594)

17103
(7758)

17851
(8097)

18612
(8442)

19065
(8648)

Chassis Dimensions - Length, Ft (mm)

379.1
(9631)

335.2
(8514)

335.2
(8514)

335.2
(8514)

379.2
(9631)

379.2
(9631)

Chassis Dimensions - Width, Ft (mm)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

88.3
(2242)

Chassis Dimensions - Height, Ft (mm)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

94.6
(2403)

7/7

8/8

9/7

113 (428)

113 (428)

% Minimum Load

10%

COMPRESSORS, SEMI-HERMETIC SCREW


Qty per Chiller

CONDENSER FANS
Number Ckt-1/Ckt-2

8/8

7/7

Air on Condenser (Min/Max), F (C )

7/7

0/125 (-17.8/51.7)

EVAPORATOR, SHELL AND TUBE HYBRID FALLING FILM 2


Water Volume, gal (liters)
L
 eaving Water Temperature
(Min/Max), F (C ) 3

71 (269)

58 (220)

82 (310)

113 (428)

40/60 (4.4/15.6)

M
 aximum Water Side Pressure,
psig (bar)

150 (10.3)

M
 aximum Refrigerant Side
Pressure, psig (bar)

235 (16.2)

Evap Drain Connection, in

3/4

NOTES:
1. Shipping and operating weights shown are for base unit; selected options may add weight to unit. Contact your nearest Johnson Controls
Sales office for weight data.
2. The evaporator is protected against freezing to 0F(-17.8C) with a standard heater.
3. For leaving liquid temperature below 40F(4.4C) or above 60F (15.6C), contact your nearest Johnson Controls Sales Office for application requirements.

52

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TABLE 4 - PHYSICAL DATA (CONT'D)


UNIT FRAME

030

030

030

031

032

CONDENSER CODE

EVAPORATOR CODE

GENERAL UNIT DATA


Number of Independent Refrigerant Circuits

Refrigerant Charge, R-134a, Ckt.-1/Ckt.-2, lbs (kg)

290/245
(132/111)

295/250
(134/114)

315/275
(143/125)

315/275
(143/134)

295/295
(134/134)

Oil Charge, Ckt.-1/Ckt.-2, gal (liters)

4.1/3.0
(15.5/11.4)

4.1/3.0
(15.5/11.4)

4.3/3.2
(16.3/12.1)

4.3/3.2
(16.3/12.5)

4.1/4.1
(15.5/15.5)

Unit shipping weight, lbs (kg) 1

17114
(7763)

18967
(8603)

18967
(8603)

19728
(8948)

18554
(8416)

Operating Weight, lbs (kg) 1

17877
(8109)

19827
(8993)

19827
(8993)

20588
(9339)

19414
(8806)

Chassis Dimensions - Length, Ft (mm)

379.2
(9631)

423.1
(10748)

423.1
(10748)

467.1
(11865)

379.2
(9631)

Chassis Dimensions - Width, Ft (mm)

88.3 (2242)

88.3 (2242)

88.3 (2242)

88.3 (2242)

88.3 (2242)

Chassis Dimensions - Height, Ft (mm)

94.6 (2403)

94.6 (2403)

94.6 (2403)

94.6 (2403)

94.6 (2403)

10/10

8/8

113 (428)

113 (428)

% Minimum Load

10%

COMPRESSORS, SEMI-HERMETIC SCREW


Qty per Chiller

CONDENSER FANS
Number Ckt-1/Ckt-2

9/7

10/8

Air on Condenser (Min/Max), F (C )

10/8
0/125 (-17.8/51.7)

EVAPORATOR, SHELL AND TUBE HYBRID FALLING FILM 2


Water Volume, gal (liters)
Leaving Water Temperature (Min/Max), F (C )

71 (269)

71 (269)

113 (428)
40/60 (4.4/15.6)

Maximum Water Side Pressure, psig (bar)

150 (10.3)

Maximum Refrigerant Side Pressure, psig (bar)

235 (16.2)

Evap Drain Connection, in

3/4

NOTES:
1. Shipping and operating weights shown are for base unit; selected options may add weight to unit. Contact your nearest Johnson Controls
Sales office for weight data.
2. The evaporator is protected against freezing to 0F(-17.8C) with a standard heater.
3. For leaving liquid temperature below 40F(4.4C) or above 60F (15.6C), contact your nearest Johnson Controls Sales Office for application requirements.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

53

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TABLE 4 - PHYSICAL DATA (CONT'D)


UNIT FRAME

033

034

034

050

052

CONDENSER CODE

EVAPORATOR CODE

GENERAL UNIT DATA


Number of Independent Refrigerant Circuits

Refrigerant Charge, R-134a, Ckt.-1/Ckt.-2, lbs


(kg)

290/290
(132/132)

310/310
(141/141)

315/315
(143/143)

405/405
(184/184)

445/445
(202/202)

Oil Charge, Ckt.-1/Ckt.-2, gal (liters)

4.1/4.1
(15.5/15.5)

4.2/4.2
(15.9/15.9)

4.3/4.3
(16.3/16.3)

5.2/5.2
(19.7/19.7)

5.4/5.4
(20.4/20.4)

Unit shipping weight, lbs (kg) 1

18224
(8266)

19315
(8761)

20077
(9107)

25968
(11779)

28427
(12894)

Operating Weight, lbs (kg) 1

18987
(8612)

20175
(9151)

20937
(9497)

27325
(12394)

29784
(13510)

Chassis Dimensions - Length, Ft (mm)

423.1
(10748)

423.1
(10748)

467.1
(11865)

467.1
(11865)

599.3
(15222)

Chassis Dimensions - Width, Ft (mm)

88.3 (2242)

88.3 (2242)

88.3 (2242)

88.3 (2242)

88.3 (2242)

Chassis Dimensions - Height, Ft (mm)

94.6 (2403)

94.6 (2403)

94.6 (2403)

94.7 (2405)

94.7 (2405)

10/10

13/13

147 (556)

147 (556)

% Minimum Load

10%

COMPRESSORS, SEMI-HERMETIC SCREW


Qty per Chiller

CONDENSER FANS
Number Ckt-1/Ckt-2

9/9

9/9

Air on Condenser (Min/Max), F (C )

10/10
0/125 (-17.8/51.7)

EVAPORATOR, SHELL AND TUBE HYBRID FALLING FILM 2


Water Volume, gal (liters)
Leaving Water Temperature (Min/Max), F (C )

71 (269)

113 (428)

113 (428)
40/60 (4.4/15.6)

Maximum Water Side Pressure, psig (bar)

150 (10.3)

Maximum Refrigerant Side Pressure, psig (bar)

235 (16.2)

Evap Drain Connection, in

3/4

NOTES:
1. Shipping and operating weights shown are for base unit; selected options may add weight to unit. Contact your nearest Johnson Controls
Sales office for weight data.
2. The evaporator is protected against freezing to 0F(-17.8C) with a standard heater.
3. For leaving liquid temperature below 40F(4.4C) or above 60F (15.6C), contact your nearest Johnson Controls Sales Office for application requirements.

54

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

The data below is applicable to select configurations.


Other configurations are available through our configuration/selection software. Please contact your nearest
Johnson Controls Sales Office for the chiller configuration that best matches your specific needs.

94.6"
(2403 mm)

C
B

LD16178

A" PIPE WATER INLET

A" PIPE WATER OUTLET

CONTROL ENTRY
3.0" (76 mm) WIDE X
11.5" (292 mm) HIGH
3.0"
(75 mm)

120"
(305 mm)

VIEW A-A

88.3" (2242 mm)

POWER ENTRY
10" (254 mm) WIDE X
13" (330 mm) HIGH

4.0"
(102 mm)
1.5"
(38 mm)

VIEW B-B

VSD / CONTROL PANEL

60.0"
(1524 mm)

14.1"
(359 mm)

47.4"
(1204 mm)

Figure 15 - YVAA DIMENSIONS


JOHNSON CONTROLS

55

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

LD15892

Table 5 - UNIT RIGGING


YVAA MODEL
Frame
015

016

017

018

019

019

020

021

021

Condenser
3

DESCRIPTION

Evaporator
B

Rigging Hole Location


Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load

UNITS

in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.

18
464
1036
470
18
464
626
284
12
314
625
283
18
464
502
228
18
464
469
213
18
464
418
190
18
464
1199
544
18
464
472
214
12
314
483
219

60
1512
1675
760
60
1533
1141
518
73
1845
1746
792
60
1533
1454
660
60
1533
1471
667
60
1533
1630
739
60
1518
750
340
60
1533
1467
665
73
1845
1990
903

116
2937
1675
760
137
3485
3081
1398
144
3654
2573
1167
143
3637
2886
1309
143
3636
2779
1261
137
3485
2443
1108
131
3332
3466
1572
143
3636
2824
1281
144
3654
1990
903

192
4866
1372
622
214
5436
1194
542
197
5012
1287
584
220
5599
1143
518
227
5761
1390
630
215
5456
1657
752
214
5430
1280
581
227
5761
1412
640
197
5012
1673
759

CENTER
OF
GRAVITY
X
Y
106
46
2682 1164

132
46
3348 1158

260
6593
1103
500

151
46
3835 1173

272
6920
256
116
302
7670
715
324

144
46
3649 1162

272
6920
257
117
260
6593
1322
600

144
45
3655 1155

132
46
3365 1161

154
46
3912 1161

114
46
2907 1168

158
46
4013 1176

Notes
1. Operating weight shown is for base unit (460/3/60, no options); selected option may add weight to unit. Contact you nearest Johnson
Controls Sales office for weight data.
2. All rigging holes are 3" x 2".

56

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

LD15892

TABLE 5 - UNIT RIGGING (CONT'D)


YVAA MODEL

DESCRIPTION

Frame

Cond

Evap

015

016

017

018

019

019

020

021

021

Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load

UNITS

in.
18
60 116 192
mm. 464 1512 2937 4866
lbs. 952 1655 1655 1496
kg.
432 751 751 679
in.
18
60 137 214
mm. 464 1533 3485 5436
lbs. 608 1121 3058 1255
kg.
276 508 1387 569
in.
12
73 144 197 260
mm. 314 1845 3654 5012 6593
lbs. 634 1612 2611 1305 1172
kg.
288 731 1184 592 532
in.
18
60 143 220
mm. 464 1533 3637 5599
lbs. 508 1422 2912 1193
kg.
230 645 1321 541
in.
18
60 143 227 272
mm. 464 1533 3636 5761 6920
lbs. 484 1419 2833 1416 264
kg.
220 644 1285 642 120
in.
18
60 137 215 302
mm. 464 1533 3485 5456 7670
lbs. 398 1633 2451 1716 715
kg.
181 741 1112 778 324
in.
18
60 131 214
mm. 464 1518 3332 5430
lbs. 1107 776 3428 1384
kg.
502 352 1555 628
in.
18
60 143 227 272
mm. 464 1533 3636 5761 6920
lbs. 485 1416 2842 1421 265
kg.
220 642 1289 645 120
in.
12
73 144 197 260
mm. 314 1845 3654 5012 6593
lbs. 475 1937 1937 1721 1387
kg.
215 879 879 781 629

CENTER
OF
GRAVITY
X
Y
106
46
2682 1164

132
46
3348 1158

151
46
3835 1173

132
46
3365 1161

144
46
3649 1162

154
46
3912 1161

114
46
2907 1168

144
45
3655 1155

158
46
4013 1176

Notes
1. Operating weight shown is for base unit (460/3/60, no options); selected option may add weight to unit. Contact you nearest Johnson
Controls Sales office for weight data.
2. All rigging holes are 3" x 2".

JOHNSON CONTROLS

57

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

LD15892

TABLE 5 - UNIT RIGGING (CONT'D)


YVAA MODEL
Frame
021

023

024

024

026

027

027

027

029

Condenser
8

DESCRIPTION

Evaporator
C

Rigging Hole Location


Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load

UNITS

in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.

12
314
518
235
18
464
342
155
18
464
358
162
12
314
697
316
18
464
515
234
12
314
736
334
12
314
872
396
12
314
616
279
12
314
500
227

73
1845
2344
1063
60
1533
2052
931
60
1533
2130
966
73
1845
1921
871
60
1533
1613
732
73
1845
1021
463
73
1845
569
258
73
1845
1372
622
73
1845
1930
875

163
4144
3047
1382
137
3484
2048
929
149
3789
2982
1353
163
4144
3078
1396
137
3484
2513
1140
121
3073
1226
556
121
3073
1525
692
121
3073
1138
516
179
4551
4518
2049

254
6443
1501
681
215
5455
2048
929
240
6088
2151
976
254
6525
1741
790
215
5455
1682
763
181
4602
3065
1390
181
4602
3812
1729
181
4602
2845
1290
290
7358
1506
683

324
8217
428
194
272
6919
144
65
324
8217
307
139
347
6525
871
395
302
7669
714
324
243
6170
1393
632
264
6717
1146
520
243
6170
1937
879
347
8825
533
242

CENTER
OF
GRAVITY
X
Y
161
46
4086 1173

140
46
3553 1160

159
46
4033 1174

177
46
4500 1172

152
45
3866 1153

324
8219
696
316
324
8218
573
260
347
8826
968
439

177
46
4506 1176

177
46
4506 1176

187
46
4747 1173

186
47
4712 1186

Notes
1. Operating weight shown is for base unit (460/3/60, no options); selected option may add weight to unit. Contact you nearest Johnson
Controls Sales office for weight data.
2. All rigging holes are 3" x 2".

58

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

LD15892

TABLE 5 - UNIT RIGGING (CONT'D)


YVAA MODEL
Frame

Cond

Evap

021

023

024

024

026

027

027

027

029

DESCRIPTION

UNITS

Rigging Hole
Location

in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.

12
314
510
231
18
464
330
150
18
464
354
161
12
314
697
316
18
464
493
224
12
314
653
296
12
314
803
364
12
314
542
246
12
314
434
197

73
1845
2282
1035
60
1533
2037
924
60
1533
2079
943
73
1845
1800
816
60
1533
1623
736
73
1845
1083
491
73
1845
586
266
73
1845
1407
638
73
1845
1937
879

163
4144
2967
1346
137
3484
2067
938
149
3789
2911
1320
163
4144
3169
1437
137
3484
2486
1128
121
3073
1174
533
121
3073
1494
678
121
3073
1099
498
179
4551
4698
2131

254
6443
1743
791
215
5455
2067
938
240
6088
2340
1061
254
6525
1773
804
215
5455
1723
782
181
4602
2936
1332
181
4602
3734
1694
181
4602
2747
1246
290
7358
1566
710

324
8217
336
152
272
6919
152
69
324
8217
261
118
347
6525
886
402
302
7669
714
324
243
6170
1527
693
264
6717
1252
568
243
6170
2054
932
347
8825
583
264

Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load

CENTER
OF
GRAVITY
X
Y
161
46
4086 1173

140
46
3553 1160

159
46
4033 1174

177
46
4500 1172

152
45
3866 1153

324
8219
763
346
324
8218
626
284
347
8826
1027
466

177
46
4506 1176

177
46
4506 1176

187
46
4747 1173

186
47
4712 1186

Notes
1. Operating weight shown is for base unit (460/3/60, no options); selected option may add weight to unit. Contact you nearest Johnson
Controls Sales office for weight data.
2. All rigging holes are 3" x 2".

JOHNSON CONTROLS

59

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

LD15892

TABLE 5 - UNIT RIGGING (CONT'D)


YVAA MODEL
Frame
030

030

030

031

032

033

034

034

050

052

Condenser
3

DESCRIPTION

Evaporator
C

Rigging Hole Location


Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole Location
Point Load

UNITS

in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.
in.
mm.
lbs.
kg.

12
314
748
339
12
314
559
254
12
314
1113
505
12
314
1028
466
12
314
701
318
12
314
550
249
12
314
1087
493
12
314
1002
454
12
305
142
64
12
305
335
152

73
1845
1875
850
73
1845
2024
918
73
1845
323
147
73
1845
575
261
73
1845
1261
572
73
1845
2052
931
73
1845
408
185
73
1845
659
299
73
1854
3568
1618
73
1854
3102
1407

161
4092
3196
1450
161
4092
3021
1370
121
3073
2182
990
121
3073
2009
911
121
3073
1250
567
163
4144
3327
1509
121
3073
2224
1009
121
3073
2048
929
181
4597
4804
2179
181
4597
5541
2513

254
6443
1748
793
254
6443
2164
982
179
4550
2182
990
179
4550
2009
911
181
4602
3125
1417
254
6443
2098
952
181
4602
2224
1009
181
4602
2048
929
238
6045
961
436
238
6045
318
144

348
8824
874
396
306
7763
302
137
243
6170
1309
594
243
6169
2022
917
243
6170
1960
889
306
7765
333
151
243
6170
1456
660
243
6170
2173
986
290
7366
2572
1167
290
7366
2792
1266

391
9941
752
341
296 391
7510 9943
1505 753
683 342
353 435
8962 11059
1580 527
717 239
347
8826
980
445
391
9942
752
341
296 392
7510 9943
1505 753
683 342
353 435
8963 11060
1580 527
717 239
435
11049
937
425
435 494
11049 12548
518 1055
235 478

CENTER
OF
GRAVITY
X
Y
175
47
4441 1184

186
47
4729 1183

196
47
4971 1183

207
46
5256 1181

186
46
4717 1171
186
46
4737 1166

196
46
4974 1169

207
46
5254 1167

204
46
5182 1168

234
46
5944 1168

Notes
1. Operating weight shown is for base unit (460/3/60, no options); selected option may add weight to unit. Contact you nearest Johnson
Controls Sales office for weight data.
2. All rigging holes are 3" x 2".

60

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

LD15892

TABLE 5 - UNIT RIGGING (CONT'D)


YVAA MODEL
FRAME COND
030

030

030

031

032

033

034

034

050

052

DESCRIPTION

EVAP

Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load
Rigging Hole
Location
Point Load

UNITS

in.
12
73 163 254 347
mm. 314 1845 4092 6443 8824
lbs.
748 1784 3464 1785 892
kg.
339 809 1571 810 405
in.
12
73 161 254 306 391
mm. 314 1845 4092 6443 7763 9941
lbs.
411 2226 2990 2374 299 752
kg.
186 1010 1356 1077 136 341
in.
12
73 121 179 243 296 391
mm. 314 1845 3073 4550 6170 7510 9943
lbs. 1073 398 2162 2162 1547 1505 753
kg.
487 181 981 981 702 683 342
in.
12
73 121 179 243 353 435
mm. 314 1845 3073 4550 6169 8962 11059
lbs.
988 650 1988 1988 2259 1580 527
kg.
448 295 902 902 1025 717 239
in.
12
73 121 181 243 347
mm. 314 1845 3072 4601 6169 8825
lbs.
604 1370 1204 3010 2060 1030
kg.
274 621 546 1365 934 467
in.
12
73 163 254 306 391
mm. 314 1845 4144 6443 7765 9942
lbs.
373 2354 2951 2387 295 752
kg.
169 1068 1339 1083 134 341
in.
12
73 121 181 243 296 392
mm. 314 1845 3073 4602 6170 7510 9943
lbs. 1038 514 2135 2135 1578 1505 753
kg.
471 233 968 968 716 683 342
in.
12
73 121 181 243 353 435
mm. 314 1845 3073 4602 6170 8963 11060
lbs.
953 765 1959 1959 2295 1580 527
kg.
432 347 889 889 1041 717 239
in.
572
12
73 181 238 290 435
mm. 14529 305 1854 4597 6045 7366 11049
lbs.
551 263 3176 5295 496 2858 518
kg.
250 119 1441 2402 225 1296 235
in.
572
12
73 181 238 290 435 494 572
mm. 14529 305 1854 4597 6045 7366 11049 12548 14529
lbs.
551 263 3176 5295 496 2858 518 1055 551
kg.
250 119 1441 2402 225 1296 235 478 250

CENTER
OF
GRAVITY
X
Y
175
47
4441 1184

186
47
4729 1183

196
47
4971 1183

207
46
5256 1181

186
46
4717 1171
186
46
4737 1166

196
46
4974 1169

207
46
5254 1167

234
46
5944 1168

234
46
5944 1168

Notes
1. Operating weight shown is for base unit (460/3/60, no options); selected option may add weight to unit Contact you nearest Johnson
Controls Sales office for weight data.
2. All rigging holes are 3" x 2".
JOHNSON CONTROLS

61

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA















Table 6 - ISOLATOR SELECTION AND MOUNTING LOCATIONS


YVAA CONFIGURATION
FRAME COND EVAP

015

DESCRIPTION

Isolator X-Dimension (in)

10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

016

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

017

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


5

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


8

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


0

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

853
(387)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

62

620
(281)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

021

851
(386)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

020

714
(324)
10
(259)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

019

734
(333)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

019

883
(401)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

018

1055
(479)
10
(263)

661
(300)

73
144
193
(1852) (3662) (4900)
1 (34)
2150
2150
635
(975)
(975)
(288)
77
118
157
220
(1943) (3000) (3985) (5589)
1 (34)
764
1788
1788
1048
(347)
(811)
(811)
(475)
81
149
187
251
(2057) (3779) (4756) (6368)
1 (34)
2308
1598
1598
1477
(1047) (725)
(725)
(670)
76
124
163
210
(1943) (3152) (4137) (5323)
1 (34)
1658
1089
1089
1655
(752)
(494)
(494)
(751)
76
118
157
208
(1939) (2997) (3982) (5295)
1 (34)
851
1315
2167
701
(386)
(596)
(983)
(318)
76
118
157
209
(1943) (3000) (3985) (5299)
1 (34)
2105
664
664
2438
(955)
(301)
(301) (1106)
76
118
157
209
(1943) (3000) (3985) (5299)
1 (34)
853
1324
2202
709
(387)
(601)
(999)
(322)
81
149
187
251
(2057) (3779) (4756) (6368)
1 (34)
2075
1706
1706
1692
(941)
(774)
(774)
(767)

281
(7132)
701
(318)
308
(7823)
603
(274)
281
(7136)
709
(322)

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA















TABLE 6 - ISOLATOR SELECTION AND MOUNTING LOCATIONS (CONT'D)


YVAA CONFIGURATION
FRAME COND EVAP

015

DESCRIPTION

Isolator X-Dimension (in)

10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

016

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

017

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


5

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


8

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


0

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

847
(384)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

JOHNSON CONTROLS

600
(272)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

021

845
(383)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

020

708
(321)
10
(259)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

019

726
(329)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

019

865
(392)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

018

981
(445)
10
(263)

655
(297)

10

11

12

13

73
144
193
(1852) (3662) (4900)
87 (2206)
2119
2119
771
(961) (961)
(350)
77
118
157
220
(1943) (3000) (3985) (5589)
87 (2206)
736
1786
1786
1100
(334) (810)
(810)
(499)
81
149
187
251
(2057) (3779) (4756) (6368)
87 (2206)
2201
1616
1616
1557
(998) (733)
(733)
(706)
76
124
163
210
(1943) (3152) (4137) (5323)
87 (2206)
1652
1085
1085
1725
(749) (492)
(492)
(782)
76
118
157
208
(1939) (2997) (3982) (5295)
87 (2206)
845
1289
2224
717
(383) (585) (1009) (325)
76
118
157
209
(1943) (3000) (3985) (5299)
87 (2206)
2121
655
655
2511
(962) (297)
(297) (1139)
76
118
157
209
(1943) (3000) (3985) (5299)
87 (2206)
847
1293
2228
717
(384) (586) (1011) (325)
81
149
187
251
(2057) (3779) (4756) (6368)
87 (2206)
1990
1711
1711
1771
(903) (776)
(776)
(803)

14

15

16

281
(7132)
717
(325)
308
(7823)
603
(274)
281
(7136)
717
(325)

63

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TABLE 6 - ISOLATOR SELECTION AND MOUNTING LOCATIONS (CONT'D)


YVAA CONFIGURATION
FRAME COND EVAP

021

DESCRIPTION

Isolator X-Dimension (in)

10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

021

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

023

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


5

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


8

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


5

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


8

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


5

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

711
(323)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

64

693
(314)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

030

652
(296)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

029

691
(313)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

027

712
(323)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

027

699
(317)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

027

663
(301)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

026

813
(369)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

024

950
(431)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

024

717
(325)
10
(263)

870
(395)

81
149
187
235
(2057) (3779) (4756) (5968)
1 (34)
2727
564
564
2431
(1237) (256)
(256) (1103)
76
118
157
209
(1943) (2999) (3984) (5298)
1 (34)
950
1426
2226
658
(431)
(647) (1010) (298)
76
128
173
220
(1943) (3260) (4391) (5579)
1 (34)
1915
1459
1459
1775
(869)
(662)
(662)
(805)
81
143
187
245
(2057) (3638) (4748) (6232)
1 (34)
1795
2030
2030
1086
(814)
(921)
(921)
(493)
76
118
157
209
(1943) (2999) (3984) (5298)
1 (34)
2111
694
694
2468
(958)
(315)
(315) (1119)
81
161
201
301
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7654)
1 (34)
1544
2775
2134
1387
(700) (1259) (968)
(629)
81
161
201
301
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7654)
1 (34)
1646
2871
2282
1435
(747) (1302) (1035) (651)
81
161
201
298
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7582)
1 (34)
1773
2533
2533
907
(804) (1149) (1149) (411)
81
161
201
296
(2057) (4095) (5105) (7512)
1 (34)
1821
2532
2532
919
(826) (1148) (1148) (417)
81
143
187
245
(2057) (3638) (4748) (6232)
1 (34)
1804
2071
2071
1083
(818)
(939)
(939)
(491)
81
144
187
277
(2057) (3663) (4755) (7047)
1 (34)
1451
2185
2185
1652
(658)
(991)
(991)
(749)

301
(7653)
1216
(552)
281
(7135)
658
(298)
301
(7654)
887
(402)
339
(8609)
1086
(493)
308
(7823)
604
(274)

339
(8609)
907
(411)
339
(8609)
919
(417)
339
(8609)
1083
(491)
383
(9726)
861
(391)
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TABLE 6 - ISOLATOR SELECTION AND MOUNTING LOCATIONS (CONT'D)


YVAA CONFIGURATION
FRAME COND EVAP

021

DESCRIPTION

Isolator X-Dimension (in)

10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

021

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

023

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


5

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


8

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


5

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


8

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


5

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

711
(323)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

JOHNSON CONTROLS

629
(285)
10
(259)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

030

598
(271)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

029

662
(300)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

027

682
(309)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

027

680
(308)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

027

663
(301)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

026

807
(366)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

024

936
(425)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

024

704
(319)
10
(263)

765
(347)

10

11

12

13

81
149
187
235
(2057) (3779) (4756) (5968)
87 (2206)
2650
571
571
2482
(1202) (259)
(259) (1126)
76
118
157
209
(1943) (2999) (3984) (5298)
87 (2206)
936
1433
2243
669
(425) (650) (1017) (303)
76
128
173
220
(1943) (3260) (4391) (5579)
87 (2206)
1825
1482
1482
1821
(828) (672)
(672)
(826)
81
143
187
245
(2057) (3638) (4748) (6232)
87 (2206)
1646
2097
2097
1102
(747) (951)
(951)
(500)
76
118
157
209
(1943) (2999) (3984) (5298)
87 (2206)
2126
671
671
2518
(964) (304)
(304) (1142)
81
161
201
301
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7654)
87 (2206)
1377
3032
1944
1516
(625) (1375) (882)
(688)
81
161
201
301
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7654)
87 (2206)
1480
3128
2092
1564
(671) (1419) (949)
(709)
81
161
201
298
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7582)
87 (2206)
1733
2527
2527
961
(786) (1146) (1146) (436)
81
161
201
296
(2057) (4095) (5105) (7512)
87 (2206)
1830
2621
2621
973
(830) (1189) (1189) (441)
81
143
187
245
(2055) (3635) (4745) (6228)
87 (2206)
1668
2245
2245
1092
(757) (1018) (1018) (495)
81
144
187
277
(2057) (3663) (4755) (7047)
87 (2206)
1551
2240
2240
1779
(704) (1016) (1016) (807)

14

15

16

301
(7653)
1241
(563)
281
(7135)
669
(303)
301
(7654)

910
(413)
339
(8609)
1102
(500)
308
(7823)
604
(274)

339
(8609)
961
(436)
339
(8609)
973
(441)
339
(8606)
1092
(495)
383
(9726)
861
(391)

65

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TABLE 6 - ISOLATOR SELECTION AND MOUNTING LOCATIONS (CONT'D)


YVAA CONFIGURATION
FRAME COND EVAP

030

DESCRIPTION

Isolator X-Dimension (in)

10
(260)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

030

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

031

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


5

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


0

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

789
(355)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

052

789
(358)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

050

801
(363)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

034

575
(261)
10
(260)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

034

702
(318)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

033

788
(357)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

032

800
(363)
10
(263)

783
(355)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

794
(360)

81
161
201
298
(2054) (4081) (5102) (7579)
1 (34)
2001
2138
2138
1857
(908)
(970)
(970)
(842)
81
161
201
298
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7582)
1 (34)
2032
2067
2067
2211
(922)
(938)
(938) (1003)
81
161
201
298
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7582)
1 (34)
1771
2699
2699
918
(803) (1224) (1224) (416)
81
143
188
245
(2057) (3636) (4781) (6232)
1 (34)
2930
891
891
3346
(1329) (404)
(404) (1518)
81
161
201
298
(2054) (4081) (5102) (7579)
1 (34)
1996
2260
2260
1909
(905) (1025) (1025) (866)
81
161
201
298
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7582)
1 (34)
2027
2188
2188
2263
(919)
(992)
(992) (1026)
81
161
201
298
(2057) (2908) (5219) (7218)
1 (34)
2027
2188
2188
2263
(1188) (1403) (1403) (1388)
81
154
205
284
(2057) (2908) (5219) (7218)
1 (34)
2619
3093
3093
3061
(1188) (1403) (1403) (1388)
81
154
206
284
(2057) (3907) (5219) (7218)
1 (34)
2611
3112
3112
2916
(1184) (1412) (1412) (1323)

383
(9723)
863
(391)
427
(10843)
1013
(459)
339
(8609)
918
(416)
383
(9726)
861
(391)
383
(9723)
863
(391)
427
(10843)
1013
(459)
427
(10843)
1013
(460)
427
(10843)
1014
(460)
427
505
562
(10842) (12820) (14265)
1202
(545)

386
(175)

759
(344)

Notes:

1. Operating weight shown is for base unit (460/3/60, no options); selected options may add weight to unit. Contact your nearest Johnson
Controls Sales Office for weight data.
2. All isolator mounting holes are 19mm

NOTE: Dimensions are in inches (mm) and weights are in pounds (kg)

66

Isolator Locations 04 08 11

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TABLE 6 - ISOLATOR SELECTION AND MOUNTING LOCATIONS (CONT'D)


YVAA CONFIGURATION
FRAME COND EVAP

030

DESCRIPTION

Isolator X-Dimension (in)

10
(260)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

030

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)
Isolator X-Dimension (in)

031

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


5

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


0

Isolator X-Dimension (in)


3

778
(349)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

052

778
(353)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

050

789
(358)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

034

441
(200)
10
(260)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

034

635
(288)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

033

778
(353)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

032

789
(358)
10
(263)

769
(349)
10
(263)

Isolator Y-Dimension (in)


Point Load (lbs)

772
(350)

10

11

12

13

14

15

16

81
161
201
298
383
(2054) (4081) (5102) (7579) (9723)
87 (2206)
1968
2235
2235
1938
863
(893) (1014) (1014) (879)
(391)
81
161
201
298
427
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7582) (10843)
87 (2206)
1999
2164
2164
2292
1013
(907) (982)
(982) (1040) (459)
81
161
201
298
339
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7582) (8609)
87 (2206)
1794
2675
2675
963
963
(814) (1213) (1213) (437)
(437)
81
143
188
245
383
(2057) (3636) (4781) (6232) (9726)
87 (2206)
3177
707
707
3601
861
(1441) (321)
(321) (1633) (391)
81
161
201
298
383
(2054) (4081) (5102) (7579) (9723)
87 (2206)
1967
2259
2259
1951
(892) (1025) (1025) (885)
81
161
201
298
(2057) (4084) (5105) (7582)
87 (2206)
1998
2187
2187
2305
(906) (992)
(992) (1046)
81
161
201
298
(2057) (2908) (5219) (7218)
87 (2206)
1998
2187
2187
2305
(1179) (1398) (1398) (1412)
81
154
205
284
(2057) (2908) (5219) (7218)
87 (2206)
2600
3083
3083
3113
(1179) (1398) (1398) (1412)
81
154
206
284
(2057) (3907) (5219) (7218)
87 (2206)
2550
3098
3098
3026
(1157) (1405) (1405) (1373)

863
(391)
427
(10843)
1013
(459)
427
(10843)
1013
(460)
427
(10843)
1014
(460)
427
505
562
(10842) (12820) (14265)
1202
(545)

386
(175)

759
(344)

Notes:

1. Operating weight shown is for base unit (460/3/60, no options); selected options may add weight to unit. Contact your nearest Johnson
Controls Sales Office for weight data.
2. All isolator mounting holes are 19mm

NOTE: Dimensions are in inches (mm) and weights are in pounds (kg)

JOHNSON CONTROLS

Isolator Locations 04 08 11

67

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

ELASTOMETRIC ISOLATOR INSTALLATION


TOP BOLT

(B)

TOP WASHER

D
(C)

CL

(B)

CL
SECTION D-D
SECTION
D-D

(A)
LD13762C

1. Read the following instructions before beginning


installation.

4. Bolt or anchor all isolators to supporting structure


utilising base thru holes (B).

2. Isolators are shipped fully assembled and are to be


positioned in accordance with the submittal drawings or as otherwise recommended.

5. Remove top bolt and top washer. Place equipment on top of isolators so that mounting holes in
equipment or base line up with threaded hole (C).

3. Set isolators on floor, housekeeping pad or subbase, ensuring that all isolators lines match the
equipment mounting holes. The VMC group recommends that the isolator base (A) be installed on
a level surface. Shim or grout as required, leveling
all isolator bases to the same elevation (0.03125inch maximum difference can be tolerated).

6. Reinstall top bolt and washer and tighten down.

68

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

ELASTOMETRIC ISOLATOR SPECIFICATIONS


DW

DW

CD

CD

MOLDED
DURULENE

MOLDED
DURULENE
HF

HF
= AD Thru
Typ 2 Places

BT

R = 0.280 Slot
Typ 2 Places

BT

AL

W
L

AL

LD17304

DIMENSION DATA (INCHES)


AL
AD
BT

MOUNT
TYPE

HF

RD1-WR

3.13

1.75

1.25

2.38

0.34

RD2-WR
RD3-WR
RD4-WR

3.88
5.50
6.25

2.38
3.38
4.63

1.75
2.88
2.75

3.00
4.13
5.00

0.34
0.56
0.56

CD

DW

0.19

5/16-18 UNC X 3/4

1.25

0.22
0.25
0.38

3/8-16 UNC X 1
1/2-13 UNC X 1
1/2-13 UNC X 1

1.75
2.50
3.00

MODEL NUMBER

ISOLATOR COLOR

WEIGHT RANGE (LBS)

WEIGHT RANGE (KGS)

RD-3-CHARCOAL-WR

CHARCOAL

Up thru 825

UP TO 374

RD-4-BRICK RED-WR
RD-4-CHARCOAL-WR

BRICK RED
CHARCOAL

826 thru 1688


1689 thru 4000

375 - 766
767 - 1814

JOHNSON CONTROLS

69

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

ONE INCH DEFLECTION ISOLATOR INSTALLATION

UPPER
HOUSING
(D)

EQUIPMENT
BASE

POSITIONING
PIN (H)

0.25 min - 0.5 max

LOWER
HOUSING

NON-SKID
ELASTOMERIC
PAD

(C)

(C)

(B)

1. Read the following instructions before beginning


installation.
2. Isolators are shipped fully assembled and are to be
positioned in accordance with the submittal drawings or as otherwise recommended.
3. Set isolators on floor, housekeeping pad or subbase, ensuring that all isolators centerlines match
the equipment mounting holes. The VMC group
recommends that the isolator base (B) be installed on a level surface. Shim or grout as required, leveling all isolator bases to the same
elevation (0.25-inch maximum difference can be
tolerated).
4. Bolt or anchor all isolators to supporting structure
utilizing base slotted holes (C).

70

5. Place equipment on top of isolators making sure


that mounting holes of the equipment line up with
isolator positioning pin (H).
6. Equipment or machine is at its full operating
weight.
7. Adjust each isolator in sequence by turning spring
adjusting bolt (D) one full counterclockwise
turn at a time. Repeat this procedure on all isolators, one at a time.
8. Continue adjusting each isolator until a minimum
of 0.25 clearance is achieved between the lower housing and upper housing. (See illustration
above).
9. Fine adjust isolators to level equipment.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

ONE INCH DEFLECTION SPRING ISOLATOR


CPX-X






5











MOUNT
TYPE

DIMENSION DATA (INCHES)


W

CP

5/8

7-3/4

6-1/2

4-3/4

1/2

5-5/8

C2P

5/8

10-1/2

9-1/4

7-3/4

9/16

MODEL NUMBER
CP-1D-510
CP-1D-900
CP-1D-1200
CP-1D-1360
CP-1D-1785N

MODEL NUMBER
C2P-1D-1350
C2P-1D-1800
C2P-1D-2400
C2P-1D-2720
C2P-1D-3570N

RATED CAPACITY (FOR UNITS WITH ALL LOAD


POINTS LESS THAN 1785 LBS (810 KG)

COLOR CODE
BLACK
DARK GREEN
GRAY
WHITE
GRAY/RED

(LBS.)

(KG)

PART NUMBER

Up thru 434
435 thru 765
766 thru 1020
1021 thru 1156
1157 thru 1785

Up thru 197
198 thru 347
348 thru 463
464 thru 524
525 thru 810

029-25334-002
029-25334-003
029-25334-004
029-25334-005
029-25334-006

RATED CAPACITY (FOR UNITS WITH ANY LOAD


POINT ABOVE 1518 LBS (689 KG)

COLOR CODE
DARK PURPLE
DARK GREEN
GRAY
WHITE
GRAY/RED

(LBS.)

(KG)

PART NUMBER

Up thru 1148
1149 thru 1530
1531 thru 2040
2041 thru 2312
2313 thru 3570

Up to 521
522 - 694
695 - 925
926 - 1049
1050 - 1619

029-25334-008
029-25334-009
029-25334-010
029-25334-012
029-25334-013

Notes:
1. Use either all CP's or all CP2's at all locations on a unit.
2. Installation requires bolting or anchoring mount to support structure with a 2 x 0.625" diameter bolts or 2 x 0.5" diameter concrete anchors.
3. All springs are designed for 50% over-travel.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

71

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TWO INCH DEFLECTION ISOLATOR INSTALLATION AND ADJUSTMENT


("A")

("E")

CL

("G")

("E")

("A")

GROMMET

CL

1/4 - 3/8 GAP

EQUIPMENT

("F")

WASHER

("E")

("F")

("C")
("B")

1. Read the following instructions before beginning


installation.
2. Isolators are shipped fully assembled and are to be
positioned in accordance with the submittal drawings or as otherwise recomended.
3. Set isolators on floor, housekeeping pad, or subbase, ensuring that all isolator centerlines match
the equipment mounting holes. The VMC group
recommends that the isolator base plates (B) be
installed on a level surface. Shim or grout as required, leveling all isolator base plates to the same
elevation (0.25-inch maximum difference can be
tolerated).
4. Bolt or anchor all isolators to supporting structure
utilizing base plate thru holes (C) or weld base
plate to supporting structure with 0.375" fillet
weld 2 long @ 4 on center around entire base
plate or as engineered for specific load and or field
conditions.
5. Isolators are shipped to the job site with (2) removable spacer shims (E) between the top plate
and the housing. These shims must be in place
when the equipment is positioned over the isolators.
6. With all shims (E) in place, position equipment
on top of plate (A) of isolator. Bolt equipment
securely to top plate of isolator using a minimum

72

("C")

of 2 x 0.625" UNC A325 GRADE 5 SAE bolts or


weld equipment or bracket to the top plate (A)
of isolator with a minimum 0.375" fillet welds 2
long @ 3 O.C. for a minimum total weld of 10.
(All sides of equipment or bracket resting on top
plate (A) must be welded).
7. The adjustment process can only begin after the
equipment or machine is at its full operating
weight.
8. Back off each of the 4 limit stop lock nuts (F) on
the isolators 0.5.
9. Adjust each isolator in sequence by turning spring
adjusting nuts (G) one full clockwise turn at a
time. Repeat this procedure on all isolators, one
at a time. Check the limit stop lock nuts (F)
periodically to ensure that clearance between the
washer and rubber grommet is maintained. Stop
adjustment of isolator only when the top plate
(A) has risen just above the shim (E).
10. Remove all spacer shims (E).
11. Fine adjust isolators to level equipment.
12. Adjust all limit stop lock nuts (F) per isolator,
maintaining 0.25-to 0.375-inch gap. The limit
stop nuts must be kept at this gap to ensure uniform bolt loading during uplift (as the case when
equipment is drained).

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TWO INCH DEFLECTION, RESTRAINED SPRING ISOLATOR CROSS REFERENCE


Y2RS
1-1/8"

5"
5/8"

2-3/4"

2-3/4"
12"

3/8" GAP

5/8-11UNC
TYP. (4)

3/4"
TYP.(4)

3/4"
7/8"

14"

12-1/4"

1/2" LIMIT
STOP &
NUT
8-3/8"
OPER.
HEIGHT

3-1/2"

3/8"
5"

MODEL NUMBER

WEIGHT RANGE (LBS)

WEIGHT RANGE (KGS)

YORK P/N

Y2RSI-2D-460
Y2RSI-2D-710
Y2RSI-2D-870
Y2RSI-2D-1200N
Y2RSI-2D-1690
Y2RSI-2D-2640N
Y2RSI-2D-2870N
Y2RSI-2D-3280N

Up thru 391
392 thru 604
605 thru 740
741 thru 1020
1021 thru 1437
1438 thru 2244
2245 thru 2618
2619 thru 3740

UP TO 177
178 - 274
275 - 336
337 - 463
464 - 652
653 - 1018
1019 - 1188
1189 - 1696

029-25336-006
029-25336-008
029-25336-009
029-25336-010
029-25336-011
029-25336-012
029-25336-013
029-25336-014

Notes:
1. All dimensions are in inches, interpret as per ANSI Y14
2. Equipment must be bolted or welded to the top plate to meet allowable seismic ratings.
3. All springs are designed for 50% overload capacity with exception of the 029-25336-013 and 029-25336-014.
4. Consult JCI for concrete installation.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

73

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA


SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

FORM_201.28-NM1.1.EN (1106)

ELASTOMETRIC ISOLATOR INSTALLATION (GB CERTIFIED UNITS)


ELASTOMETRIC ISOLATOR INSTALLATION
(B")
(B)

Top Bolt

Top Bolt

Top Washer

(C")
(C)

EE

E
E

Top Washer

(B")
(B)
(A")
(A)

Section E-E
E-E
Section

LD16179

1. Read the following instructions before begin


ning installation.

4. Bolt or anchor all isolators to supporting structure


utilizing base thru holes (B).

2. Isolators are shipped fully assembled and are to


top bolt and top washer. Place equip1. be
Read
the following instructions before beginning 5. Remove
required,
leveling all isolator bases to the same
positioned in accordance with the submittal
ment on top of isolators so that mounting holes
installation.
elevation. The maximum difference that can be
drawings
or as otherwise recommended.
in equipment or base line up with threaded hole
(C). tolerated is 0.03125" (0.78 mm).
2.
are shipped
assembled pad
and or
are to be
3. Isolators
Set isolators
on floor,fully
housekeeping
positioned
in accordance
with thecenterlines
submittal draw- 6. Reinstall
4. Bolttop
or bolt
anchor
isolators
to the supporting
strucsubbase,
ensuring
that all isolators
and all
washer
and tighten
down.
ings orthe
as otherwise
ture utilizing base thru holes (B).
match
equipmentrecommended.
mounting holes. It is
recommends that the isolator base (A) be

3. installed
Set isolators
on the
floor, Shim
housekeeping
on a level
surface.
or grout aspad or
subbase, leveling
ensuring
that allbases
isolator
centerlines
required,
all isolator
to the same
match the(0.03125"
equipment(0.78
mounting
It is recelevation
mm) holes.
maximum
ommended
the isolator base (A) be installed
difference
canthat
be tolerated).
on a level surface. Shim or grout the isolator as

52

74

5. Remove the top bolt and top washer. Place equipment on top of the isolators so that the mounting
holes in the equipment or base line up with the
threaded hole (C).
6. Reinstall the top bolt and washer and tighten the
bolt down.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

FORM_201.28-NM1.1.EN (1106)

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

ELASTOMETRIC ISOLATOR SPECIFICATIONS (GB CERTIFIED UNITS)


ELASTOMETRIC ISOLATOR SPECIFICATIONS
A
A
BB

4-F

Top Bolt
Bolt
Top
Top
Washer
Top Washer

4-F

E
E
W

(C")
(C")

W
C

E
E

(B")
(B")
(A")
(A")

5 5

CC

W E-E
Section
Section E-E

LD16180

CC

DIMENSION DATA (mm)

MOUNT TYPE

MOUNT
TYPE

A JG 1

C
WDATA (MM)
H
DIMENSION

146

C95

125 W

150

55

D3

M16M

13

JG 1

146JG 2

95 176

125
125

150150

183

55 65

34

M20
M16

13 13

JG 2

176

125

65

M20

13

MODEL NUMBER

150

(LBS.)
JG 1-1
JG 1-2
JG 1-3

183

RATED CAPACITY
(FOR UNITS WITH ALL LOAD POINTS LESS THAN 1984 LBS
MODEL
(900 KG))
NUMBER
Weight Range
PART NUMBER
(LBS.)
(KG)
RATED
CAPACITY
JG 1-1
028G00031A035
331 thru 661
150 thru 300
FOR UNITS WITH ALL LOAD POINTS LESS THAN
1984 LBS (900 KG)
JG 1-2
028G00031A036
662 thru 1213
301 thru 550
WEIGHT
RANGE
JG 1-3
028G00031A037
1214 thru 1984
551 thru 900

RANGE (KG)

PART NUMBER

RATED CAPACITY

331 thru(FOR
661 UNITS WITH ALL LOAD
150 thru
300 LESS THAN 4409028G00031A035
POINTS
LBS

MODEL
NUMBER662 thru 1213

(2000
KG))
301
thru
550
Weight Range
1214 thru 1984
551
thru 900
(LBS.)
(KG)
JG 2-1
882 thru 1984
400 thru 900
JG 2-2
1985 thru 3527
901 thru 1600
JG 2-3
3528 thru 4409
1601 thru 2000

028G00031A036

PART NUMBER
028G00031A037
028G00031A038
028G00031A039
028G00031A040

RATED CAPACITY
Notes:
1. All dimensions are in millimeter.
FOR UNITS WITH ALL LOAD POINTS LESS THAN 4409 LBS (2000 KG)
2.
Use either
all JG 1's or all JG 2's at all locations on a unit
MODEL
NUMBER
WEIGHT
RANGE
3. Installation requires bolting or anchoring mount to support
structure with
a 4 x 0.5122"(4 x 13.0mm) diameter bolts or 2 x 0.5"(2 x 12.7mm ) diameter
PART NUMBER
concrete anchors
(LBS.)

RANGE (KG)

JG 1-1

882 thru 1984

400 thru 900

028G00031A038

JG 1-2

1985 thru 3527

901 thru 1600

028G00031A039

JG 1-3

3528 thru 4409

1601 thru 2000

028G00031A040

Notes:
1. All dimensions are in millimeters.
2. Use either all JG 1's or all JG 2's at all locations on a unit.
3. Installation requires bolting or anchoring mount to support structure with 4 x 0.5122" (4 x 13.0
mm) diameter bolts or 2 x 0.5" (2 x 12.7mm) diameter concrete anchors.
JOHNSON CONTORLS

JOHNSON CONTROLS

53

75

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

FORM_201.28-NM1.1.EN
(1106)
ONE INCH DEFLECTION ISOLATOR INSTALLATION (GB CERTIFIED
UNITS)

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

ONE INCH DEFLECTION ISOLATOR INSTALLATION

Upper
Housing

Upper Housing

B
B

PositioningPin (H)
Positioning
PIN(H)

(D)
(D)

Lower
Lower Housing

Housing

Non-skid
Non-skid
Elastometric
Elastomeric
Pad

(C)

(C)
(C)

Pad

BB
Section
A-A
Section
A-A
A
A

1. Read the following instructions before beginning


1. installation.
Read the following instructions before beginning
installation.
2. Isolators
are shipped fully assembled and are to be
positioned
accordance
the submittal
2. Isolators areinshipped
fullywith
assembled
and are drawto be
ings
or
as
otherwise
recommended.
positioned in accordance with the submittal drawings isolators
or as otherwise
3. Set
on therecommended.
floor, housekeeping pad or

ensuring
that housekeeping
all the isolatorpad
centerlines
3. subbase,
Set isolators
on floor,
or submatch
the equipment
mountingcenterlines
holes. It match
is recbase, ensuring
that all isolators
ommended
that
the
isolator
base
(B)
be
installed
the equipment mounting holes. It is recommends
on
level
surface.
or grout
the isolators
thata the
isolator
baseShim
(B) be
in- stalled
on a levelas
required,
leveling
all isolator
bases leveling
to the same
surface. Shim
or grout
as required,
all
elevation.
Thetomaximum
difference
that can be
isolator bases
the same elevation
(0.25"(6.3mm)
maximumisdifference
be tolerated).
tolerated
0.25" (6.3can
mm).

4. Bolt
Bolt or
or anchor
anchor all
all isolators
isolators to
to the
supporting
structure
4.
supporting
strucutilizing
base
slotted
holes
(C).
ture utilizing base slotted holes (C).

76
54

(B)
(B)

Section B-B
Section
B-B
A
A

LD16181

5. Place the equipment on top of the isolators making sure


that theon
mounting
holes onmaking
the equipment
5. Place
equipment
top of isolators
sure
line
up
with
the
isolator
positioning
pin up
(H).
that mounting holes of the equipment line
with
pin (H).
6. isolator
Ensurepositioning
the equipment
is at full operating weight

before adjusting
the isolators.
6. Equipment
or machine
is at its full operating
weight.
7. Adjust each isolator in sequence by turning the
springeach
adjusting
(D) oneby
full
counterclock7. Adjust
isolatorbolt
in sequence
turning
spring
wise turn
at (D)
a time.
this procedure turn
on all
adjusting
bolt
one Repeat
full counterclockwise
atisolators,
a time. Repeat
procedure on all isolators,
one at athis
time.
one at a time.
8. Continue adjusting each isolator until the same
8. Continue
isolator
until housing
same
clearance adjusting
is achievedeach
between
the lower
clearance
is achieved
between
lower housing
and the upper
housing
for all the
isolators.
and upper housing for all isolators.
9. Fine adjust isolators to level the equipment.
9. Fine adjust isolators to level equipment.

JOHNSON CONTROLS
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

FORM_201.28-NM1.1.EN (1106)

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

ONE INCH DEFLECTION ISOLATOR SPRING ISOLATOR (GB CERTIFIED UNITS)


ONE INCH DEFLECTION SPRING ISOLATOR
CP-X CP-X

WA

WA

Upper
Upper Housing

B
B

Housing

WB
WB

M16

M16
Positioning
Positioning Pin (H)
PIN(H)

(D)
(D)
H

Non-skid

(C)
(C)

Non-skid
Elastomeric
Elastometric
Pad
Pad

B
B

(C)
(C)

(B)
(B)

B
B
LL
Section
A-A
Section A-A

Section B-B
Section
B-B

B
B
LL

MOUNT
TYPE

WA

CP-2

190

MOUNT TYPE

CP-4

193

MODEL NUMBER
CP-2-200
CP-2-300
CP-2-400
CP-2-550
CP-2-680
CP-2-820

WB
CP-2 70
CP-4

130

MODEL

SPRING
NUMBER
NUMBER
2
2
2
2
2
2

CP-2-200
CP-2-300
CP-2-400
CP-2-550
CP-2-680
CP-2-820

MODEL
NUMBER

MODEL NUMBER

SPRING
NUMBER
CP-4-400
CP-4-550
4 CP-4-680
CP-4-820
4
CP-4-1100
4 CP-4-1360
4 CP-4-1630

5
5

A
A

A
A

TH

TH

Lower

Lower Housing
Housing

LD16182

DIMENSION
DATA (mm)
DIMENSION
DATA (MM)
WA
190
193

H WB
168 70

H
TH

TH B

168
211

211
228

130

160

160

202

202

228

228 270 270


228
270

270

DD
1616
16

16

WW
8080
142

142

RATED CAPACITY
RATED
CAPACITY
(FOR UNITS
WITH
ALL LOAD POINTS LESS THAN 1808
FOR
UNITS
WITH ALL LOAD POINTSLBS
LESS
THAN
(820
KG))1808 LBS (820 KG)
Spring
Number
Weight Range
WEIGHT RANGE
PART
NUMBER
PART
NUMBER
(LBS.)
(KG)
(LBS.)
RANGE (KG)
2
Up thru 441
Up thru 200
028G00031A028
Up thru2441
200
028G00031A028
442 thru 661Up thru
201
thru 300
028G00031A029
442 thru2 661
300
028G00031A029
662 thru 882201 thru
301
thru 400
029G23000A018
029G23000A019
883 thru 1213
401
thru 550
662 thru2 882
301 thru
400
029G23000A018
028G00031A030
1214 thru 1499
551
thru 680
883 thru21213
401 thru
550
029G23000A019
029G23000A020
2
1500 thru 1808
681 thru 820

1214 hru 1499


1500 thru 1808

551 thru 680


681 thru
820 CAPACITY
RATED

028G00031A030
029G23000A020

(FOR UNITS WITH ALL LOAD POINTS LESS THAN 3594


LBS (1630 KG))
RATED
WeightCAPACITY
Range
PART NUMBER
FOR UNITS WITH ALL LOAD
(LBS.) POINTS LESS
(KG)THAN 3594 LBS (1630 KG)
WEIGHTUpRANGE
029G23000A021
4
thru 882
Up thru 400
PART NUMBER
029G23000A022
4
883 thru 1213
thru 550
(LBS.)
RANGE401
(KG)
029G23000A023
1214 thru 1499
thru 680
Up thru4882
Up thru551
400
029G23000A021
029G23000A024
4
1500 thru 1808
681 thru 820
883 thru 1213
401 thru 550
029G23000A022
029G23000A025
4
1809 thru 2425
821 thru 1100
1214 thru4 1499
551
thru
680
029G23000A023
029G23000A026
2426 thru 2998
1101 thru 1360
1500 thru4 1808
681 thru
820
029G23000A024
029G23000A027
2999 thru 3594
1361
thru 1630
Spring Number

CP-4-400
CP-4-550
CP-4-680
CP-4-820
Notes:
CP-4-1100
4
1809 thru 2425
1. All dimensions are in millimeter.
CP-4-1360
4
2426 thru 2998
2. Use either all CP-1's or all CP-2's at all locations on a unit.
CP-4-1630
4
2999 thru 3594

821 thru 1100


1101 thru 1360
1361 thru 1630

029G23000A025
029G23000A026
029G23000A027

3. Installation requires bolting or anchoring mount to support structure with a 2 x 0.625"(2x16mm) diameter bolts or 2 x 0.5"(2x12.7mm) diameter
concrete anchors.

Notes:
1. All dimensions
are inCONTORLS
millimeters.
JOHNSON
2. Use either all CP-2's or all CP-4's at all locations on a unit.
3. Installation requires bolting or anchoring mount to support structure with 2 x 0.625" (2x16 mm) diameter bolts or 2 x 0.5" (2x12.7mm) diameter concrete anchors.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

55

77

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

ECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

FORM_201.28-NM1.1.EN (1106)

TWO INCH DEFLECTION ISOLATOR INSTALLATION AND ADJUSTMENT


(GB CERTIFIED
UNITS)
TWO INCH DEFLECTION ISOLATOR
INSTALLATION
AND ADJUSTMENT
M16
M16 Bolt/Washer
Bolt/Washer

(A)
(A)

(A)
Equipment
Equipment

(G)
(G)

(F)
(F)
(C)

(C)
(C)

SectionA-A
A-A
Section

A
A

1. Read the following instructions before beginning


1. Read the following instructions before beginning
installation.
installation.

(B)
(B)

A
A

LD16183

5. Ensure the equipment is at full operating weight


7. Place equipment on top of isolators making sure
before adjusting the isolators.

that mounting holes of the equipment line up with

2. Isolators
are shipped
fullyfully
assembled
and
2. Isolators
are shipped
assembled
andare
areto
to be
be
positioned
in
accordance
with
the
submittal
drawpositioned in accordance with the submittal drawings or as
otherwise
recommended.
ings
or as otherwise
recommended.

6. Bolt
or anchor
all bolt.
isolators to the supporting strucisolator
M16
ture utilizing the base slotted holes (C).

3. Set isolators
on the
floor, housekeeping
or
3. Set isolators
on floor,
housekeeping
pad, orpad,
subsubbase, ensuring that all isolator centerlines
base, ensuring
that all isolator centerlines match
match the equipment mounting holes. It is recomthe equipment
mounting
holes.
It is (B)
recommends
mends that
the isolator
base plates
be installed
that the on
isolator
base
plates
(B)
be
installed
onasa
a level surface. Shim or grout the isolators
required,
leveling
all isolator
bases to leveling
the same
level surface.
Shim
or grout
as required,
elevation.
The
maximum
difference
that
can be
all isolator base plates to the same elevation
tolerated is 0.25"
(6.35 mm).
(0.25"(6.35mm)
maximum
difference can be
4. Bolt or anchor all isolators to the supporting structolerated).

at a time. Continue adjusting each isolator until


8. Adjust
isolator inissequence
by turning
springthe lower
sameeach
clearance
achieved
between
adjusting
nuts
(G)
one
full
clockwise
turn
at a stop lock
housing and top plate. Check the limit
time. Repeat this procedure on all isolators, one
nuts (F) periodically to ensure that clearance
at a time. Continue adjusting each isolator until
between
the washer
and grommet
maintained.
the
same clearance
is achieved
between theislower

ture utilizing base plate thru holes (C) or weld


4. Bolt or anchor
isolators
supporting
structure
the baseall
plate
to the to
supporting
structure
with
fillet holes
weld 2"(50.8mm)
long @
4"
utilizing0.375"
base (9.5mm)
plate thru
(C) or weld
base
center around
the0.375"(9.5mm)
entire base plate;
plate to (101.6mm)
supportingonstructure
with
or
as
engineered
for
specific
load
and or field confillet weld 2"(50.8mm) long @ 4"(101.6mm)
on
ditions.

centre around entire base plate or as engineered


for specific load and or field conditions.

5. The adjustment process can only begin after the


equipment or machine is at its full operating
78
weight
6. Bolt or anchor all isolators to supporting structure

8. Adjust each isolator in sequence by turning spring

7. Place
equipment
top of
isolators
making turn at a
adjusting
nutson(G)
onethefull
clockwise
sure
that
mounting
holes
of
the
equipment
up
time. Repeat this procedure on allline
isolators,
one
with the isolator M16 bolt.

and top plate. Check the limit stop lock


8.housing
Fine adjust
isolators to level equipment.

nuts (F) periodically to ensure that clearance bethe washer


and grommet
is maintained.
9.tween
Adjust
all limit
stop lock
nuts (F) per isolator,
maintaining
0.25"(6.3mm)
to 0.375"(9.5mm) gap.
9. Fine
adjust the isolators
to level equipment.

The limit
stop
be per
keptisolator,
at this gap to
10. Adjust
all limit
stopnuts
lockmust
nuts (F)
ensure
uniform
bolt
loading
during
maintaining a gap between 0.25" (6.3mm)uplift
to (as the
case when
equipment
drained)
0.375"
(9.5mm).
The limit isstop
lock nuts must
be kept at this gap to ensure uniform bolt loading during uplift (as is the case when equipment
is drained)
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

FORM_201.28-NM1.1.EN (1106)

SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA

TWO INCH DEFLECTION, RESTRAINED SPRING ISOLATOR


TWO INCH DEFLECTION,
RESTRAINED
(GB CERTIFIED
UNITS) SPRING ISOLATOR
ZGT-F2

ZGT-F2

AA
WA
WA

(A)
(A)

WB
WB

(A)
(A)

M16
M16 Bolt/Washer
Bolt/Washer

Equipment
Equipment

(G)
(G)

TH

TH

(F)
(F)

(C)
(C)

(C)
(C)
BB
LL

(B)
(B)

D
D
W
W

Section
SectionA-A
A-A
4-F

4-F

D
W

55

LD16184

A
A

BB
LL

MOUNT TYPE

MOUNTTYPE
ZGT-F2

ZGT-F2

DIMENSION DATA (mm)


A

WA

WB

290

110

110

WA

290

110

MODEL NUMBER
ZGT-F2-200
ZGT-F2-300
ZGT-F2-350
ZGT-F2-500
Notes:

WB
110

110

TH

DIMENSION DATA (MM)


110

150

150

TH

200

200

B
283

283

L
310

310

D
60

60

F
16

RATED CAPACITY
(FOR UNITS WITH ALL LOAD POINTS LESS THAN 3527
(1600 KG)
MODEL NUMBER
RATED LBS
CAPACITY
Weight Range
PARTLBS
NUMBER
FOR UNITS WITH ALL LOAD POINTS LESS THAN 3527
(1600 KG)
(LBS.)
(KG)
WEIGHT
ZGT-F2-200
0 thruRANGE
441
0 thru 200
029G23000A031
PART NUMBER
ZGT-F2-300
442 thru 661
201 thru 300
029G23000A032
(LBS.)
RANGE
(KG)
ZGT-F2-350
662 thru 772
301 thru 350
029G23000A033
0 thru 441
0 thru
029G23000A031
ZGT-F2-500
773 thru 1102
351200
thru 500
029G23000A034
ZGT-F2-650
1103 thru 1433 201 501
029G23000A035
442 thru 661
thru thru
300650
029G23000A032
ZGT-F2-1000
1434 thru 2205
651 thru 1000
029G23000A036
662 thru 772
thru thru
3501200
029G23000A033
ZGT-F2-1200
2206 thru 2646 3011001
029G23000A037
ZGT-F2-1600
2647
thru
3527
1201
thru
1600
029G23000A038
773 thru 1102
351 thru 500
029G23000A034

ZGT-F2-650
1103 thru 1433
1. All dimensions are in millimeter.

501 thru 650

2. Equipment must be bolted or


welded
to the
top plate to meet allowable
ratings.
ZGT-F2-1000
1434
thru
2205
651seismic
thru 1000
3. Consult JCI for concrete installation.

029G23000A035
029G23000A036

ZGT-F2-1200

2206 thru 2646

1001 thru 1200

029G23000A037

ZGT-F2-1600

2647 thru 3527

1201 thru 1600

029G23000A038

Notes:
1. All dimensions are in millimeters.
2. Equipment must be bolted or welded to the top plate to meet allowable seismic ratings.
3. Consult Johnson Controls for concrete installation.
JOHNSON CONTORLS

JOHNSON CONTROLS

16

57

79

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 6 - COMMISSIONING
PREPARATION
Commissioning of this unit should only
be carried out by Johnson Controls Authorized personnel.

Commissioning personnel should be thoroughly familiar with the information contained in this document before starting the unit.
The following basic checks should be made with the
customer power to the unit switched OFF.
Proper electrical lock out and tag out
procedures must be followed.

Inspection
Inspect unit for installation damage. If found, take action and/or repair as appropriate.
Refrigerant Charge
Packaged units are normally shipped as standard with a
full refrigerant operating charge. Check that refrigerant
pressure is present in both systems and that no leaks
are apparent. If no pressure is present, a leak test must
be undertaken, the leak(s) located and repaired.
Do not evacuate or liquid charge with static water in
the evaporator. Turn the pump on. Take care to liquid
charge slowly to avoid excessive thermal stress at the
charging point and to assure the refrigerant temperature in the evaporator does not go below the freezing
point with liquid refrigerant in the evaporator. Once
the vacuum is broken, charge into the evaporator or
flash tank with the Condenser Drain Valve (Flash Tank
Feed) open and the chilled liquid pump ON to the full
operating charge, as detailed in SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA on Page 49.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

Correct System Refrigerant Charge


The charge on a system should always be checked
when operating for several minutes at full speed with
the system stable. Stable conditions are defined as operation without fan cycling, economizer cycling, VI
solenoid cycling, or any other system transient conditions. Ideal refrigerant charge will be reached when the
refrigerant level in the evaporator is near the middle of
the evaporator sight glass.
Refrigerant should not be added or removed unless the level is at the bottom or
the top of the glass. It is not necessary to
weigh charge unless the entire charge has
been lost. The ease of charging is possible
since the microchannel coils hold only
a small amount of refrigerant charge.
A charging valve is located between the
fixed orifice and the evaporator for adjusting charge. Charge should be added
as liquid with the pump ON and liquid
flowing through the evaporator.
Service and Oil Line Valves
Open each compressor oil, economizer, and discharge
ball or service valves. If valves are of the back-seat
type, open them fully (counterclockwise) then close
one turn of the stem to ensure operating pressure is fed
to pressure transducers.
Compressor Oil
To add oil to a circuit - connect a YORK hand oil pump
(Part No. 470-10654-000) to the 1/4" (6.35 mm) oil
charging valve on the oil separator piping with a length
of clean hose or copper line, but do not tighten the flare
nut. Using clean oil of the correct type (L oil), pump
oil until all air has been purged from the hose then
tighten the nut. Stroke the oil pump to add oil to the oil
system. While the compressor is running at full speed,
the oil level should be visible in the sight glass of the
oil separator. Approximately 2 to 3.1 gallons (7.5 to
11.6 liters) are present in each refrigerant system.

81

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 6 - COMMISSIONING

Avoid levels in either oil separator that are above the


middle of the top sight glass. This may cause excessive oil carryover in the system. High oil concentration
in the system may cause nuisance trips resulting from
incorrect readings on the level sensor and temperature
sensors. Temperature sensor errors may result in poor
liquid control which will result in liquid overfeed and
subsequently damage the compressor. High oil carryover may also cause liquid to be returned to the compressor, which can damage the compressor.
Fans
Check that all fans are free to rotate and are not damaged. Ensure blades are at the same height when rotated. Ensure fan guards are securely fixed.
Isolation / Protection
Verify all sources of electrical supply to the unit are
taken from a single point of isolation. Check that the
maximum recommended fuse sizes given in SECTION
5 - TECHNICAL DATA on Page 49 has not been exceeded.
Control Panel
Check the panel to see that it is free of foreign materials
(wire, metal chips, etc.) and clean out if required.
Power Connections
Check that the customer power cables are connected correctly to the terminal blocks or optional circuit breaker.
Ensure that connections of power cables within the panels to the circuit breaker or terminal blocks are tight.
Grounding
Verify that the units protective ground terminal(s) are
properly connected to a suitable grounding point. Ensure that all unit internal ground connections are tight.
Water System
Verify the chilled liquid system has been installed correctly, and has been commissioned with the correct direction of water flow through the evaporator. The inlet
should be at the bottom connection on a two pass evaporator. Purge air from the top of the evaporator using the
plugged air vent mounted on the top of the evaporator
body.
Flow rates and pressure drops must be within the limits given in SECTION 5 - TECHNICAL DATA on Page
49. Operation outside of these limits is undesirable
and could cause damage.
82

If main power must be switched OFF for extended


maintenance or an extended shutdown period, precautions must be taken. If there is a possibility of
liquid freezing due to low ambient temperatures, the
evaporator should be drained or power should be applied to the chiller. This will allow the evaporator
heater to protect the evaporator from freezing down to
0F (-17.7C). Before placing the unit back in service,
valves should be opened and power must be switched
on (if power is removed for more than 8 hours) for at
least 8 hours (24 hours if ambient temperature is below
86F [30C]) before the unit is restarted.
Flow Switch
Verify a chilled water flow switch is correctly fitted
in the customers piping on the evaporator outlet, and
wired into the control panel correctly using shielded
cable.
There should be a straight run of at least five pipe diameters on either side of the flow switch. The flow switch
should be connected to Terminals 2 and 13 in the panel.
Temperature Sensor(s)
Ensure the leaving liquid temperature sensor is coated
with heat conductive compound (Part No. 013-00890000) and is inserted to the bottom of the water outlet
sensor well in the evaporator. This sensor also provides
some freeze protection and must always be fully inserted in the water outlet sensor well.
Programmed Options
Verify that the options factory-programmed into the
Micro Panel are in accordance with the customers
order requirements by pressing the OPTIONS key on
the keypad and reading the settings from the display.
Programmed Settings
Ensure the system cutout and operational settings are in
accordance with the operating requirements by pressing the PROGRAM key.
Date and Time
Program the date and time by first ensuring that the CLK
jumper JP2 on the Chiller Control Board is in the ON
position. Then press the DATE/TIME key and set the
date and time (see SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL Date/
Time and Schedule Keys on Page 120).

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 6 - COMMISSIONING

Start/Stop Schedule

Oil Pressure

Program the daily and holiday start/stop by pressing


the SCHEDULE key (see SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL
Date/Time and Schedule Keys on Page 120).

When a compressor starts, press the relevant System


Pressures key and verify that oil differential pressure
(oil pressure-suction pressure) develops immediately.
If oil pressure does not develop, the automatic controls will shut down the compressor. Under no circumstances should a restart attempt be made on a compressor, which does not develop oil pressure immediately.
Switch the UNIT switch to the OFF position.

Setpoint and Remote Offset


Set the required leaving chilled liquid temperature
setpoint and Control Range under the SETPOINTS key.
The chilled liquid temperature control settings need to
be set according to the required operating conditions.
If remote temperature reset (offset) is to be used,
the maximum reset required must be programmed
by pressing the SETPOINTS key (see SECTION 8 MICROPANEL Setpoints Key on Page 112).
FIRST TIME START UP
During the commissioning period there
should be sufficient heat load to run the
unit under stable full load operation to
enable the unit controls, and system operation to be set up correctly, and a commissioning log taken.
Interlocks
Verify that liquid is flowing through the evaporator
and that heat load is present. Ensure that any remote
run interlocks are in the run position and that the Daily
Schedule requires the unit to run or is overridden.
Unit Switch
Place the UNIT switch on the keypad to the ON position.
Startup
Press the SYSTEM SWITCHES key and place the
system switch for System 1 to the ON position. There
may be a few seconds delay before the first compressor starts because of the anti-recycle timer). Be ready
when each compressor starts, to switch the UNIT
switch OFF immediately, if any unusual noises or other
adverse conditions develop.
When a compressor is running, the controller monitors
oil pressure, motor current, and various other system
parameters such as discharge pressure, chilled liquid
temperature, etc. Should any problems occur; the control system will immediately take appropriate action
and display the nature of the fault.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

Loading
Once the unit has been started, all operations are fully
automatic. After an initial period at minimum capacity,
the control system will adjust the unit load depending
on the chilled liquid temperature and rate of temperature change. If a high heat load is present, the controller will increase the speed of the compressor(s).
Condenser and Fan Rotation
Once a compressor is running, discharge pressure rises
as refrigerant is pumped into the air-cooled condenser
coils. This pressure is controlled by stages of fans to
ensure maximum unit efficiency while maintaining
sufficient pressure for correct operation of the condensers and the lubrication system.
As discharge pressure rises, the condenser fans operate
in stages or ramp up in speed to control the pressure.
Verify that the fans operate in the correct direction of
rotation and operation is correct for the type of unit.
System Charge
Check system charge at steady full compressor load
only. It is important that all fans are running for the
system. The refrigerant level in the evaporator should
be about in the middle of the sight glass. Unless levels are at the bottom or the top of the sight glass, they
should not cause concern or require adding or removing charge.
General Operation
After completion of the above checks for System 1,
switch OFF the SYS 1 switch on the keypad and repeat
the process for each subsequent system. When all run
correctly, stop the unit, switch all applicable switches
to the ON position and restart the unit.
Assure all checks are completed in the Equipment Pre Startup and Startup Checklist. The chiller is then ready
to be placed into operation.

83

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 7 - OPERATION
The keypad also contains keys in the center section for
data entry in the various program modes. These keys
are listed below:

OPERATING CONTROLS
DISPLAY

0-9 Keys NUMERIC KEYPAD


PERIOD/DECIMAL
+/- PLUS/MINUS
ENTER
CANCEL
UP ARROW
DOWN ARROW

LEFT ARROW
RIGHT ARROW
LD10605

KEYPAD

UNIT
SWITCH

The numeric keys allow keying numeric values into


memory.

Figure 16 - KEYBOARD AND DISPLAY

The (PERIOD/DECIMAL) key allows keying a


decimal point into numeric values.

Unit Switch

The +/- (PLUS/MINUS) key allows making numeric


values negative.

A double pole single throw ON/OFF rocker switch on


the front of the control panel is used to turn the entire
chiller ON and OFF. When the switch is placed in the
OFF position, the entire unit shuts down immediately
and all systems will be disabled. One pole of the UNIT
switch contacts is wired to the Run Signal input and the
Chiller Control Board UNIT switch X digital input
(X equals System 1 or 2). Separate System Fuses are
also wired in series with each set of UNIT switch contacts. If either fuse is pulled or blown, only the system
with the good fuse (Input is high) will run. When both
inputs are high, the entire chiller will be enabled to run.
When both inputs are low, the chiller will be disabled
as a UNIT switch OFF Shutdown.
Keypad
An operator keypad allows complete control of the system from a central location. The keypad offers a multitude of command keys on the left and right side of the
keypad to access displays, program setpoints, history
data, and initiate system commands. Most keys have
multiple displays that can be accessed by repetitively
pressing the key or by pressing the ,,, and
(ARROW) keys. The keypad utilizes an overlay to
convert the keypad to various languages.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

The (ENTER) key stores program changes into


memory.
The X (CANCEL) key is used to cancel the data entry operation and returns the programmed value to the
original value, before any programming changes were
made, when an error is made.
The (UP ARROW) and (DOWN ARROW)
keys allow scrolling backward () and forward ()
through items to be programmed under keys such as the
PROGRAM or OPTIONS key.
The (UP ARROW) and (DOWN ARROW)
keys also allow scrolling forward () or backwards
() through data display keys that have multiple
displays under keys such as UNIT DATA, SYSTEM
DATA, HISTORY, PROGRAM, OPTIONS, etc. The
arrow keys can be used instead of repeatedly pressing
the data key to see the multiple displays under a key.
Once the (ARROW) keys are pressed and used
for scrolling, pressing the original data key will return
to the first display message displayed under the data
(UNIT DATA, SYSTEM DATA, etc.) keys.

85

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 7 - OPERATION

The (LEFT and RIGHT ARROW) keys allow


scrolling between non-numeric program choices under
the OPTION, DATE/TIME, and SCHEDULE keys.
The (LEFT ARROW) key allows programming the
default value when programming numeric values. For
changing numeric values, the (RIGHT ARROW)
key has no function.
The (ARROW) keys also allow scrolling sideways between the same displays on different systems.
For example, pressing the (RIGHT ARROW) key
while viewing the system #1 suction pressure moves the
display to system #2 suction pressure.
Pressing the (LEFT ARROW) key moves the
opposite direction. The arrow keys also allow fast
scrolling through data under keys such as HISTORY
by enabling the operator to move between subgroups
of data such as Unit, System, and VSD data.
Keypad Data Entry Mode
For numeric programmable items, the data entry mode
is entered by pressing any of the number keys, the decimal point key, or the +/- key. When the data entry mode
is entered, the data from the key press will be entered
and the cursor will appear under the position where the
data is being entered.
For non-numeric programmable items, data entry
mode is entered by pressing the or (ARROW)
keys. When the data entry mode is entered, the cursor
will appear under the first position of the non-numeric
string. The programmable choice may be changed by
pressing the or (ARROW) keys.
To exit the data entry mode and store the programmed
value, the (ENTER) key must be pressed. When
the (ENTER) key is pressed, the cursor will disappear.
The data entry mode may also be exited by pressing
the X (CANCEL) key. The programmed data will be
returned to its original value when the X (CANCEL)
key is pressed.
When the data entry mode is exited, the cursor will disappear. If any other key is pressed while in the Data
Entry Mode, the following display will appear for 2
seconds indicating the user must choose between
accepting or canceling the change:
XXXXXXXXXXX PRESS

TO ACCEPT VALUE OR

X TO CANCEL DATA ENTRY

86

If the (ENTER) key was pressed from the data entry mode and the numeric value entered was out of
range, the following message will appear for 2 seconds
followed by the original data display.
XXXXXXXXXXX OUT OF RANGE TRY AGAIN!
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

Display
The 80 character (2 lines of 40 characters per line)
display is a Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) used for
displaying unit parameters, system parameters, and
operator messages. The display has an LED backlight
background for night viewing and is viewable in direct
sunlight.
Anti-recycle Timer
On power-up of the control panel, the anti-recycle timer for each system will be set to 120 seconds and must
time out before a compressor is allowed to start.
Whenever a system starts, the anti-recycle timer for all
systems will be set to 120 seconds and will count down
from the time the motor starts. The timer must time out
before another compressor is allowed to start.
Whenever a system shuts down, the anti-recycle timer
for that system will be set to 120 seconds. The timer
must time out before the system is allowed to restart.
Evaporator Pump Control
The evaporator pump dry contacts are energized when
any of the following conditions are true:
If a Low Leaving Chilled Liquid Fault occurs.
Whenever a compressor is running.
The Daily Schedule is ON and the UNIT switch
is ON.
Even if one of above is true, the pump will not run if
the panel has been powered up for less than 30 seconds
or if the pump has run in the last 30 seconds to prevent
pump motor overheating.
Evaporator Heater Control
The evaporator heater is controlled by ambient
air temperature. If no systems are running and the
ambient temperature drops below 4.4 C (40F), the
heater is turned ON. If no systems are running and
the temperature rises above 7.2C (45F) the heater is
turned OFF. Whenever a system is running, the evapo-

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

rator heater is turned OFF. Both evaporator heater outputs will always be turned ON and OFF together. An
under voltage condition will keep the heater OFF until
full voltage is restored to the system.The heater will
protect the evaporator from freeze-up down to -29C(20F ).

SECTION 7 - OPERATION

BASIC OPERATING SEQUENCE


Start Sequence and Loading
To initiate the start sequence of the chiller, the following conditions must be satisfied before the precharge
of the DC Bus will take place:

Compressor Heater Control

UNIT SWITCH must be ON.

Each compressor has its own heater. The purpose of


the heater is to assure refrigerant does not condense
in the compressor. There is no oil sump, but refrigerant could possibly condense in the rotors or the motor
housing.The heater will be OFF whenever the respective compressor is running. As soon as the compressor
shuts OFF, the heater will turn ON as long as all motor
temperature sensors in the compressor read less than
70C (158F). The heater will turn OFF, if any internal
compressor motor temperature sensor reads more than
71.1C (160F).

At least one System Switch is ON

Alarms

Leaving Chilled Liquid Setpoint is above the


Setpoint plus CR (Setpoint High Limit).

Each system has its own alarm. The Alarm output is ON


(dry contact closed) when no fault condition is present and OFF (dry contact open) to indicate an alarm
situation. The Alarm will be activated (contacts open),
if any of the following are true.
A System is faulted or inhibited from starting for
more than 5 seconds.
The Unit is faulted or inhibited from starting for
more than 5 seconds.
A System is locked out.
The Unit is locked out.
Power is removed from the chiller.
Chiller Run Contact
The Chiller Run dry contact is closed whenever any system is running. It is open when all systems are shut OFF.
Flow Switch Control
A chilled liquid flow switch of suitable type MUST be
connected between Terminals 2 and 13 of 1TB to provide protection against loss of liquid flow, which will
cause evaporator freeze-up if the chiller is permitted
to run.
Remote Run / Stop
A Remote Run/Stop input is available for each system.

Run permissive inputs (Remote Cycling Contacts) must be closed.


No unit faults exist.
No unit start inhibits exist.
At least one system not faulted or inhibited.
The Daily Schedule is calling for the chiller to
run.
The Flow Switch is closed.

Once the precharge takes place, if the anti-recycle timer is timed out the chiller control system on the Chiller
Control Board will select the number of compressors
to start and begin operation of the compressors. The
compressor(s) speed will be ramped to the minimum
start frequency and increase speed as needed in an effort to regulate the leaving chilled liquid temperature
to meet the desired Setpoint.Unit Warnings
UNIT WARNING
Unit Warning Operation
Unit warnings are caused when a condition is present requiring operator intervention to restart the unit.
All setpoints, program values, and options should be
checked before operating the unit. Warnings are not
logged to the history buffer. If a unit warning is in
effect, the message will be displayed to the operator
when the STATUS key is pressed.
Low Battery Warning
The LOW BATTERY WARNING can only occur at
unit power-up. On micropanel power-up, the RTC battery is checked to see if it is still operational. If it is,
normal unit operation is allowed. If the battery voltage
is determined to be low, the following warning message is displayed indefinitely.
UNIT WARNING: !! LOW BATTERY !!
CHECK SETPOINTS/PROGRAM/OPTIONS/TIME

JOHNSON CONTROLS

87

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 7 - OPERATION

If a low battery condition exists, all programmed


setpoints, program values, time, schedule, and history
buffers will have been lost. These values will all be reset to their default values, which may not be the desired
operating values. Once a bad battery is detected, the
unit will be prevented from running until the MANUAL OVERRIDE key is pressed. Once the MANUAL
OVERRIDE key is pressed, the anti recycle timers will
be set to the programmed default anti recycle time to
allow the operator sufficient time to check setpoints,
program values, etc.
If a low battery is detected, it should be replaced as
soon as possible. The programmed values will all be
lost and the unit will be prevented from running on the
next power interruption.
Invalid Number of Compressors Warning
The INVALID NUMBER OF COMPRESSORS SELECTED Warning will occur after the VSD has been
initialized, if no Number of Compressors Select
jumpers are installed or if more than 1 jumper is installed. The following warning message will be displayed indefinitely.
UNIT WARNING:
INVALID NUMBER OF COMPRESSORS SELECTED

To clear this warning, both the control panel and VSD


control voltage must be turned OFF and the jumpers
properly installed in the VSD wiring harness.
These jumpers are factory installed in the
wire harness plug and should not require
changes.

Invalid Serial Number Warning


If the INVALID SERIAL NUMBER message appears,
immediately contact Johnson Controls Product Technical Support. The appearance of this message may mean
the chiller has lost important factory programmed information. The serial number can be entered using the
SERVICE key.
UNIT WARNING: INVALID SERIAL NUMBER
ENTER UNIT SERIAL NUMBER

This status message can be bypassed to view additional


messages under the STATUS key by pressing the STATUS key repeatedly to scroll through as many as three
STATUS messages that could possibly be displayed at
any time.
88

UNIT SAFETIES
Unit Safety Operation
Unit faults are safeties that cause all running compressors to be shut down, if a safety threshold is exceeded
for 3 seconds. Unit faults are recorded in the history
buffer along with all data on the unit and system operating conditions. Unit faults are auto reset faults where
the unit will be allowed to restart automatically after
the fault condition is no longer present. The only exception is any of the VSD related unit faults. If any 3
VSD unit faults occur within 90 minutes, the unit will
be locked out on the last fault. A VSD lockout condition requires a manual reset using the system switches.
Both system switches must be cycled OFF and ON to
clear a VSD unit lockout fault. If a unit safety is in
effect, the message will be displayed to the operator
when the STATUS key is pressed.
In the descriptions of the fault displays that follow, the
fault message will show a YYYYYYY to indicate that a
system is in a FAULT condition and will restart when
the fault clears or LOCKOUT and will not restart until
the operator clears the fault using the keypad.
If a control panel safety occurs after the VSD fault, but
before the fault is reset, the control panel fault is an
ALL FAULT of the VSD fault, meaning it will be registered as such in the History because it occurred while
the VSD was shutting down or while the systems were
shut down. All faults do not store operating data at the
time of the fault.
If a VSD fault occurs during the fault rampdown or
while the systems are shut down, the VSD fault will
be registered as a new fault. The reason for this is the
belief any VSD fault should be registered with a full
account of the systems data at the time of the fault.
High Ambient Temp Fault
If the ambient temperature rises above 54C (130F),
the chiller will shut down with a controlled ramped
shutdown. Restart will automatically occur, if demand
allows, when temperature falls 1.1C (2F) below the
cutout (52.9C[128F]). This fault cannot cause a lockout. The fault display message will be present only during the time when the ambient temperature is causing a
fault condition. A sample display is shown below:
UNIT YYYYYYYY
HIGH AMBIENT TEMP

The unit will also be inhibited from starting any time


the temperature is above 52.9C (128F).
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

Low Ambient Temp Fault


If the ambient temperature falls below the programmable Low Ambient Temp Cutout the chiller will shut
down with a controlled ramped shutdown. This fault
will only occur if the Low Ambient Cutout is ENABLED under the OPTIONS key. Restart can occur,
if demand allows, when temperature rises 1.1C (2F)
above the cutout. This fault cannot cause a lockout.
The fault display message will be present only during
the time when the ambient temperature is causing a
fault condition. A sample display is shown below:
UNIT YYYYYYYY
LOW AMBIENT TEMP

The unit is also inhibited from starting any time the


temperature is below the cutout plus 1.1C (2F).
Low Leaving Chilled Liquid Temp Fault
The Low Leaving Chilled Liquid Temp Cutout helps to
protect the chiller from an evaporator freeze-up should
the chilled liquid temp drop below the freeze point.
This situation could occur under low flow conditions
or if the Micro Panel setpoint values are improperly
programmed. Any time the leaving chilled liquid temperature (water or brine) drops below the programmable cutout point, the chiller will fault and shutdown
with a controlled ramped shutdown. Restart can occur,
if demand allows, when chilled liquid temperature rises
2.2C (4F) above the cutout. This fault cannot cause a
lockout. A sample shutdown message is shown below:
UNIT YYYYYYYY
LOW LEAVING CHILLED LIQUID TEMP

The unit is inhibited from starting any time the chilled


liquid temperature is below the cutout plus 2.2C (4F).
VSD Communications Failure Fault
The VSD Communications Failure is to prevent the
unit from trying to run, if the Chiller Control Board
never initializes communications with the VSD Logic
Board. The unit will also shut down with a controlled
ramped shutdown if the Chiller Control Board loses
communications with the VSD Logic Board while the
chiller is operating.
On power-up, the Chiller Microprocessor Board will
attempt to initialize communications with the VSD
Logic Board. The control panel will request data from
the VSD, which includes the number of compressors
and the VSD software version. Once these data points
have been received by the Chiller Control Board, and
JOHNSON CONTROLS

SECTION 7 - OPERATION

have been successfully initialized, the Chiller Control


Board will not request them again. If the comms connection fails to occur and a reply from the VSD Logic
Board does take place in 8 seconds, the Chiller Control Board will prevent the chiller from operating and a
fault message will be displayed.
During normal operation, if the control panel Chiller
Control Board receives no valid response to messages
for 8 seconds, the unit will shut down all compressors
on a Comms fault. The Chiller Control Board will continue to send messages to the VSD while faulted. The
unit will be inhibited from starting until communications is established. The fault will automatically reset
when the Chiller Control Board receives a valid response from the VSD for a data request. Shown below
is an example of a Comms Failure fault message:
UNIT YYYYYYYY
VSD COMMUNICATIONS FAILURE

SYSTEM SAFETIES (FAULTS)


System Safety (Fault) Operation
System safeties are faults that cause individual systems
to be shut down if a safety threshold is exceeded for 3
seconds. System faults are auto reset faults in that the
system will be allowed to restart automatically after the
120 second anti-recycle timer times out. The only exception is after any 3 faults on the same system occur
within 90 minutes, that system will be locked out on
the last fault. The lockout condition requires a manual
reset using the system switch. The respective system
switch must be cycled OFF and ON to clear the lockout
fault.
When multiple systems are operating and a system
fault occurs, the running systems will ramp down and
the faulted system will be shut OFF and the previously
operating will restart if required after the fault clears
and/or the 120 second anti-recycle timer times out.
In the descriptions of the fault displays that follow, the
fault message will show a YYYYYYYY to indicate
that a system is in a FAULT condition and will restart when the fault clears, or LOCKOUT and will
not restart until the operator clears the fault using the
keypad. If a system safety is in effect, the message will
be displayed to the operator when the STATUS key is
pressed.
In some cases, a control panel fault will occur after
a VSD fault, possibly during system shutdown or at
some later time. This is known as an ALL FAULT
89

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 7 - OPERATION

and these faults will be recorded as such under the


HISTORY information stored at the instant of the primary fault. In some cases, this information may be
valuable in troubleshooting the primary fault. An example of the ALL FAULT history message is shown
on page 106 under the HISTORY key. When an ALL
FAULT occurs, associated history information will
not be stored. If an additional fault does not occur, the
ALL FAULTS display will indicate NONE.
In cases where a VSD fault occurs during the rampdown of a control panel fault (i.e.: low suction pressure,
low water temp, etc.), the VSD fault will be stored as a
new fault with the associated fault information stored
at the instant the VSD fault occurred (i.e.: IGBT Gate
Drive, Single Phase Input, VSD CT Plug, etc.). The
control panel fault that occurred prior to the VSD fault
will be stored with the associated complete data related
to the fault as a numerically lower numbered history in
the history buffers.
High Discharge Pressure Cutout (Software)
Fault
The High Discharge Pressure Cutout is a software
fault. A system will fault and shut down with a controlled ramped shutdown on high discharge pressure
when the discharge pressure rises above 22.4 barg (325
PSIG) for 0.5 seconds. The system will be allowed to
restart when the discharge pressure falls to 20.3 barg
(295 PSIG). The system will also be inhibited from
starting if the pressure is above 20.3 barg (295 PSIG).
The fault message for this safety is shown below:
SYS X YYYYYYYY HIGH DISCHARGE PRESSURE

The X indicates the system and YYYYYYYY indicates the system is in a FAULT condition and will
restart when the 120 second anti-recycle timer times
out, or LOCKOUT and will not restart until the operator clears the fault using the keypad.
High Discharge Pressure Cutout
(HPCO) (Hardware) Fault
The mechanical High Pressure Cutout protects the
system from experiencing dangerously high discharge
pressure. A system will fault and shut down immediately when the mechanical high pressure cutout contacts open. The fault will occur immediately and not
wait 3 seconds, which is typical of most system faults.
The HPCO is wired in series with the VSD Run Signal
and will only be checked by the Chiller Control Board

90

when the system is running. The mechanical cutout


opens at 23.2 barg 0.55 barg (337 PSIG 8 PSIG)
and closes at 17.4 barg 0.69 barg (252 PSIG 10
PSIG). The Status display fault message for this system is shown below:
SYS X YYYYYYYY HPCO FAULT

The X indicates the system and YYYYYYY indicates


the system is in a FAULT condition and will restart
when the 120 second anti-recycle timer times out or
LOCKOUT and will not restart until the operator
clears the fault using the keypad.
Low Suction Pressure Cutout (Software) Fault
The programmable Low Suction Pressure Cutout is
a secondary back-up for the flow switch and protects
against operation with low refrigerant charge, which
helps protect the chiller from an evaporator freeze-up,
should the system attempt to run with a low refrigerant
charge. The Status display fault message for this cutout is shown below:
SYS X YYYYYYYY LOW SUCTION PRESSURE

The X indicates the system and YYYYYYY indicates


the system is in a FAULT condition and will restart
when the 120 second anti-recycle timer times out or
LOCKOUT and will not restart until the operator
clears the fault using the keypad. Typically, the cutout
will be set at 1.65 barg (24 PSIG) for chilled water applications.
The cutout is ignored for the first 30 seconds of system
run time. During the next 3 minutes of run time the
cutout point is linearly ramped from 10% of the cutout
value up to the programmed cutout point. If at any time
during the first 3 minutes of operation the suction pressure falls below the ramped cutout point, the system
will shut down with a controlled ramped shutdown.
The cutout pressure during operating periods of 30 seconds to 210 seconds is ramped and can be calculated
by:
(Programmed Cutout x Run Time) -1.2 PSIG
200
After the first 3 minutes and 30 seconds of run time, if
the suction pressure falls below the cutout as a result
of a transient in the system, a transient timer is set at
30 seconds and a linearly ramped cutout is set startCutout =

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

ing at 10% of the programmed cutout. If over the next


30 seconds, the suction pressure does not stay above
the ramped cutout, which ramps between 10% of the
cutout and the programmed cutout over the 30 second
period, the system will fault on low suction pressure.
Low Motor Current Cutout Fault
The Motor Current Cutout shuts the system down with
a controlled ramped shutdown when the microprocessor detects the absence of motor current (less than 10%
FLA), usually indicating that a compressor is not running. This safety is ignored for the first 10 seconds of
operation.
The status display fault message for this safety is
shown below:
SYS X YYYYYYYY LOW MOTOR CURRENT

The X indicates the system and YYYYYYY indicates


the system is in a FAULT condition and will restart
when the 120 second anti-recycle timer times out or
LOCKOUT and will not restart until the operator
clears the fault using the keypad.
High Differential Oil Pressure Cutout Fault
The High Differential Oil Pressure Cutout protects the
compressor from low oil flow and insufficient lubrication, possibly from a dirty oil filter. A system will fault
and shut down with a controlled ramped shutdown
when its Discharge to Oil Differential Pressure rises
above the cutout of 4.48 bard (65 PSID). This safety is
ignored for the first 90 seconds of run time. This safety
measures the pressure differential between discharge
and oil pressure, which is the pressure drop across the
oil filter. The Status display fault message for this safety is shown below:
SYS X YYYYYYYY HIGH DIFF OIL PRESSURE

The X indicates the system and YYYYYYY indicates


the system is in a FAULT condition and will restart
when the 120 second anti-recycle timer times out or
LOCKOUT and will not restart until the operator
clears the fault using the keypad.
Low Differential Oil Pressure Cutout Fault
The Low Differential Oil Pressure Cutout protects the
compressor from low oil flow and insufficient lubrication. A system will fault and shut down with a controlled

JOHNSON CONTROLS

SECTION 7 - OPERATION

ramped shutdown when its differential between oil


and suction pressure falls below the cutout. This safety
assures that the compressor is pumping sufficiently to
push oil through the oil cooling circuit and through the
internal compressor lubrication system. The Status display fault message for this safety is shown below:
SYS X YYYYYYYY LOW DIFF OIL PRESSURE

The X indicates the system and YYYYYYY indicates


the system is in a FAULT condition and will restart
when the 120 second anti-recycle timer times out or
LOCKOUT and will not restart until the operator
clears the fault using the keypad.
The safety is ignored for the first 60 seconds of run
time. After the first 60 seconds of operation, the cutout
is linearly ramped from 0 bard to 2.09 bard (0 PSID to
30 PSID) in 5 to 10 minutes based on ambient temperature. See the following table for the ramp times for the
given ambient temperatures.
Table 7 - LOW DIFFERENTIAL OIL PRESSURE
CUTOUT
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE

RAMP
TIME

more than 10C (50F)

5 Minutes

more than 7.2C (45F)

6 Minutes

more than 4.4C (40F)

7 Minutes

more than 1.6C (35F)

8 Minutes

more than 1.1C (30F)

9 Minutes

more than or equal to 1.1C (30F)

10 Minutes

A 30 second safety bypass below 50 Hertz is employed


during rampdown. The bypass is primarily needed
under conditions where another compressor is being brought on and the running compressor is being
ramped down to 5 Hertz to add the additional compressor due to load requirements. Under these conditions,
the slow speed of the running compressor(s) causes the
oil differential to become very low, especially if the
water temperature is high and the suction pressure is
high. The bypass assures the compressor(s) will not
trip on a nuisance low oil differential fault.
High Discharge Temperature Cutout Fault
The High Discharge Temperature Cutout protects the
motor and compressor from overheating. A system will
fault and shut down with a controlled ramped shutdown
when its Discharge Temperature rises above 121C

91

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 7 - OPERATION

(250F). A system will also be inhibited from starting if


the discharge temperature is above 93C (200F). The
Status display fault message for this safety is shown
below:
SYS X YYYYYYYY HIGH DISCHARGE TEMP

The X indicates the system and YYYYYYY indicates


the system is in a FAULT condition and will restart
when the 120 second anti-recycle timer times out or
LOCKOUT and will not restart until the operator
clears the fault using the keypad.
Low Discharge Superheat Cutout Fault
The Low Discharge Superheat safety helps protect the
compressor from liquid floodback through the economizer line due to a high flashtank level. It also helps
protect the compressor from excessive oil in circulation due to excess oil charge in the system.Excessive
oil in circulation brings back liquid refrigerant which
is entrained in the oil. The liquid then drops out once it
enters the compressor.
The safety is ignored for the first 10 minutes of operation if the system economizer feed valve is closed
(0%) and for 5 minutes of operation if the economizer
feed valve is open greater than 0%. If the discharge superheat falls below 2.8C (5.0F) for 5 minutes under
either condition, the system will shut down.
The X indicates the system and YYYYYYY indicates
the system is in a FAULT condition and will restart
when the 120 second anti-recycle timer times out or
LOCKOUT and will not restart until the operator
clears the fault using the keypad.
Sensor Failure Cutout Fault
The Sensor Failure Cutout prevents the system from
running when a critical sensor (transducer, level sensor, or motor winding temp sensor) is not functioning properly and reading out of range. This safety is
checked at startup and will prevent the system from
running if one of the sensors has failed.
The sensor failure safety will also fault and shutdown
a system while in operation, if a safety threshold is exceeded or a sensor reads out of range (high or low).
Following is the Status display fault message.

SYS X YYYYYYYY SENSOR FAILURE:


ZZZZZZZZZZZZ

The X indicates the specific system.


YYYYYYYY will either indicate the system
is in a FAULT condition and will restart
when the fault clears, or LOCKOUT
after 3 faults and will not restart until the
operator clears the fault using the keypad.
ZZZZZZZZZZZ indicates the failed sensor below:
SUCT PRESS
OIL PRESS
DSCH PRESS
MOTOR TEMP X *
*The Unit Setup Mode allows a specific motor temperature sensor
to be ignored, if it fails.

The start inhibit thresholds for each sensor are shown


in the following table.
Table 8 - START INHIBIT SENSOR THRESHOLDS
SENSOR

LOW
THRESHOLD

HIGH
THRESHOLD

SUCTION
TRANSDUCER

0.3VDC

4.7VDC

OIL
TRANSDUCER

0.3VDC

4.7VDC

DISCHARGE
TRANSDUCER

0.3VDC

4.7VDC

MOTOR TEMP.
SENSOR

0C (0F)

116C (240F)

High Motor Temperature Cutout Fault


The High Motor Temperature Cutout prevents a compressor from running when its motor temperature is too
high. A system will fault and shut down when any compressor motor temperature sensor rises above 121C
(250F). The system will be inhibited from starting if
its motor temperatures sensors indicate temperatures
above 116C (240F). If any single temperature sensor is being ignored under the Unit Set-up Mode, that
sensor will not be utilized when evaluating motor temperature.
Below is a sample Status display fault message:
SYS X YYYYYYYY HIGH MOTOR TEMP

92

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

The X indicates the system and YYYYYYY indicates


the system is in a FAULT condition and will restart
when the fault clears or LOCKOUT and will not restart until the operator clears the fault using the keypad.
System Control Voltage Cutout Fault
The System Control Voltage Cutout alerts the operator
the 115VAC Control voltage to one of the systems is
missing. This could be due to a system fuse that has
been removed or is blown. The affected system will
fault and shut down immediately when the 115VAC
supply is lost.
The safety will not shut down a system if the UNIT
switch is OFF, which electrically removes the 115VAC
to all systems. The safety is only used to indicate a
situation where a single system is missing the 115VAC.
The safety will not cause a lockout and the system fault
will reset when power is returned. A sample message
is shown below:
SYS X YYYYYYYY CONTROL VOLTAGE

The X indicates the system and YYYYYYY indicates


the system is in a FAULT condition and will restart
when the fault clears or LOCKOUT and will not restart until the operator clears the fault using the keypad.

SECTION 7 - OPERATION

The control algorithm looks at the eductor line temperature once a second. At start, a clog timer is set at 600
seconds. If the eductor line temperature is less than the
saturated suction temperature plus 5.5C (10F) each
time the control circuit looks at the temperature, the
clog timer is reset to 600 seconds.
If the eductor line temperatures is greater than the saturated suction temperature plus 5.5C (10F), the clog
timer is decremented one second. If the temperature
remains above the saturated suction temperature plus
5.5C (10F) for 600 seconds, the clog timer will count
to 0 and the system will shut down and lock out. The
status fault will indicate an eductor clog fault.
EDUCTOR CLOG FAULT

Whenever this fault occurs, the eductor filter should be


changed.
The clog timer resets to 600 seconds whenever the control algorithm sees the eductor line temperature is less
than the saturated suction pressure plus 5.5C (10F).
This prevents nuisance eductor clog faults.

Eductor Clog Fault


To sense a loss of oil return to the compressor, an eductor clog detection safety is utilized. The safety monitors the temperature of the line between the eductor
and the suction line.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

93

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL
STATUS KEY
STATUS
KEY

LD10605

Status Key Operation


The STATUS key displays the current chiller or system operational status. The messages displayed include running status, cooling demand, system faults,
unit faults, VSD faults, unit warnings, external device
status, load limiting, anti-recycle timer, status of unit/
system switches, and a number of other messages.
Pressing the STATUS key will enable the operator to
view the current status of the chiller. The display will
show one message relating to the highest priority information as determined by the microprocessor. There
are three types of status data, which may appear on the
display:

Unit status messages occupy 2 lines of the Status message display. If no unit status message applies, individual status messages for each system will be displayed.
Any time the STATUS key is pressed or after the
EPROM message disappears at power-up, a status display indicating chiller or system status will appear.
Multiple STATUS messages may appear and can be
viewed by pressing the STATUS key repeatedly to allow scrolling through as many as three STATUS messages, which could possibly be displayed at any time
on a 2 compressor chiller.

General Status messages

Examples of the typical Status messages are shown in


the next topic

Unit Safeties

General Status Messages

System Safeties.
When power is first applied to the control panel, the
following message displaying York International Corporation, the EPROM version, date, and time will be
displayed for 2 seconds, followed by the appropriate
general status message:
(C)2004 YORK INTERNATIONAL CORPORATION

UNIT STATUS
MANUAL OVERRIDE

This message indicates the chiller is operating in


MANUAL OVERRIDE mode. This message is a priority message and cannot be overridden by any other
STATUS message. When in Manual Override, no other
status message will ever be present.

C.XXX.XX.XX 18-SEPT-2010 12:45: AM


JOHNSON CONTROLS

95

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

UNIT STATUS
UNIT SWITCH OFF SHUTDOWN

This message indicates the UNIT SWITCH is in the


OFF position and not allowing the unit to run.
UNIT STATUS
DAILY SCHEDULE SHUTDOWN

This message indicates that either the daily or holiday schedule programmed is keeping the chiller from
running.
UNIT STATUS
REMOTE CONTROLLED SHUTDOWN

This message indicates that either an ISN or RCC has


turned the chiller OFF and is not allowing it to run.
UNIT STATUS
FLOW SWITCH SHUTDOWN

This message indicates the flow switch is not allowing


the chiller to run. There is a 1 second delay on this safety
to assure the flow switch did not momentarily open.
UNIT STATUS
VSD COOLING SHUTDOWN

This message indicates the chiller is shutdown, but


running all the condenser fans, VSD glycol pump, and
VSD fan in an effort to bring the internal VSD ambient
temperature down to an acceptable level before allowing the chiller to start.
SYS X REMOTE RUN CONTACT IS OPEN

This message indicates the remote start/stop contact between 2 and 15 or 2 and 16 of the 1TB terminal block is
open. There is a 1 second delay on this safety to assure
the remote contacts did not momentarily open.
SYS X SYSTEM SWITCH IS OFF

This message indicates the system switch (software via


keypad) is turned OFF. The system will not be allowed to
run until the system switch is turned ON via the keypad.
SYS X NOT RUNNING

This message indicates the system is not running because the chilled liquid is below the setpoint or the
micro has not loaded the lead system far enough into
the loading sequence to bring the lag system ON. This
96

message will be displayed on the lag system until the


loading sequence is ready for the lag system to start.
SYS X COOLING DEMAND SHUTDOWN

This message is only displayed in the Normal Shutdown History display to indicate a capacity control
shutdown.
SYS X COMPRESSOR RUNNING

This message indicates the system is running as a result


of cooling demand.
SYS X SHUTTING DOWN

The compressor shutting down message indicates the respective system is ramping down in speed prior to shutting OFF. This message is displayed after the software
run signal is disabled until the VSD notifies the Chiller
Control Board the compressor is no longer running.
SYS X ANTI-RECYCLE TIMER

= XXX SEC

This message indicates the amount of time left on the


respective system anti-recycle timer and the system is
unable to start until the timer times out.
SYS X DISCHARGE PRESSURE LIMITING

The Discharge Pressure Limiting message indicates


the discharge pressure load limit or discharge pressure
unloading is in effect.
SYS X SUCTION PRESSURE LIMITING

The Suction Pressure Limiting message indicates the


suction pressure load limit or suction pressure unloading is in effect.
SYS X MOTOR TEMP LIMITING

The Motor Temp Limiting message indicates the motor


temp load limit or motor temp unloading is in effect.
SYS X MOTOR CURRENT LIMITING

The motor current limiting message indicates the motor current load limit or motor current unloading is in
effect.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SYS X PULLDOWN MOTOR CURRENT LIMITING

The pulldown motor current limiting message indicates


the pulldown motor current load limit or pulldown
motor current unloading is in effect based on the programmed setpoint.

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

SYS X VSD INTERNAL AMBIENT TEMP LIMITING

The VSD Internal Ambient Temp Limiting message indicates the VSD internal ambient temp is high and load
limit or unloading is in effect.
SYS X SOUND LIMITING

SYS X ISN CURRENT LIMITING

The ISN Current Limiting message indicates the motor


current load limit or motor current unloading is in effect through the use of the YORKTalk setpoint.
SYS X REMOTE MOTOR CURRENT LIMITING

The Remote Motor Current Limiting message indicates


the motor current load limit or motor current unloading
is in effect through the use of the remote setpoint offset.The setpoint may be offset using a remote voltage
or a current signal. The remote current limit must be
activated for this function to operate.
SYS X VSD BASEPLATE TEMP LIMITING

The VSD Baseplate Temp Limiting message indicates


the VSD Baseplate temp is high and load limit or unloading is in effect.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

The sound limiting message indicates the sound load


limit is in effect based on the locally programmed
sound limit from the keypad. The sound limit must be
activated for this function to operate.
SYS X ISN SOUND LIMITING

The ISN sound limiting message indicates the sound


load limit is in effect based on the ISN transmitted
sound limit setpoint. The sound limit must be activated
for this function to operate.
SYS X REMOTE SOUND LIMITING

The Remote sound limiting message indicates the


sound load limit is in effect based on the Remote controlled sound limit setpoint. The setpoint may be offset
using a remote voltage or current signal. The sound
limit option must be activated for this function to operate.

97

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

UNIT DATA KEY


UNIT DATA
KEY

LD10605

General

UNIT

The UNIT DATA key provides the user with displays


of unit temperatures, and unit related data. Displays
can be selected by repeatedly pressing the UNIT DATA
key or the or Arrow Keys.

Unit Data Key Operation


The first key press displays Evaporator Leaving and
Return Chilled Liquid Temperatures.
UNIT CHILLED LIQUID LEAVING = XXX.X F

ENTERING = XXX.X F

The next key press of the UNIT DATA key or the


(ARROW) key displays the ambient air temperature.
UNIT
OUTSIDE AMBIENT AIR TEMP = XXX.X F

The next key press will display the time remaining on


the load and unload timers.
UNIT

LOAD TIMER = XXX SEC


UNLOAD TIMER = XXX SEC

The next key press displays the error in temperature


between the actual leaving chilled liquid temperature
and the setpoint temperature. The display also shows
the rate of change of the chilled liquid temperature.
98

TEMP ERROR = XXX.X F


RATE = XXX.X F/M

The next key press displays the system designated as the


lead system and the Flow Switch status (ON or OFF).
UNIT

LEAD SYSTEM NUMBER = X

FLOW SWITCH = XXX

The next key press displays the status of the evaporator pump and heater, where XXX is either ON or OFF.
UNIT

EVAP PUMP RUN = XXX

EVAP HEATER = XXX

The next key press displays the status of Active Remote Control.
UNIT ACTIVE REMOTE CONTR0L = XXXXXX
TYPE: RCC ISN CURR TEMP SOUND

XXXXX is either ACTIVE or NONE.


If no remote keys are active, the items on the second
line are all blanked out. Any remote items that are active will be displayed, while the inactive items will be
blanked out.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

The types of remote control are listed as follows:


NONE - No remote control is actively controlling
the chiller; however, remote monitoring by a remote device may still be active.
RCC - A Remote Control Center is providing remote control. The chiller is in remote mode.

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

The next key press displays the sound limit values as set
under the PROGRAM key by the Local, ISN, and the
Remote Sound Limit Inputs. Any sound limits that are
inactive will display XXX instead of a numeric value.
UNIT SOUND LIMIT

ISN = XXX

LOCAL = XXX %
REMOTE = XXX %

ISN - YorkTalk via ISN. The chiller in remote


mode.
CURR - Remote Current Limiting is enabled.
TEMP - Remote Temperature Reset is enabled.
SOUND - Remote Sound Limiting is enabled.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

99

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

SYSTEM DATA KEYS 1 THROUGH 4

SYSTEM 1
DATA KEY
SYSTEM 2
DATA KEY

SYSTEM 3
DATA KEY
SYSTEM 4
DATA KEY

LD10605

General
The data keys provide the user with many displays of
individual system temperatures, pressures, and other
operating data. These keys have multiple displays,
which can be seen by repeatedly pressing the SYSTEM
DATA or the or (Arrow) keys. An explanation of
each key and its messages is provided below.
System 1 Data Key Operation
The SYSTEM 1 DATA key provides the user with access to System 1 operating parameters. The following
is a list of the data in the order in which it appears.
The first key press of the SYSTEM X DATA key displays all of the measured system pressures (oil and discharge).
SYS 1 PRESSURES

OIL = XXXX PSIG


DISCHARGE = XXXX PSIG

The second key press of the SYSTEM DATA key or


the (DOWN ARROW) key displays system suction
and condenser liquid pressure.

SYS 1 PRESSURES
SUCTION = XXXX PSIG

100

CONDENSER LIQUID = XXXX PSIG

The next key press displays system oil and eductor


temperatures.
SYS 1 TEMPERATURES

OIL = XXX.X F
EDUCTOR = XXX.X F

The next key press displays system condenser liquid


temperature, liquid line subcooling and saturated discharge temperature on the liquid line.

SYS 1 CONDENSER LIQUID TEMP = XXX.X F
SUBCOOLING = XXX.X SAT TEMP = XXX.X F

The next key press displays discharge temperature,


discharge superheat and saturated discharge pressure
at the compressor.
SYS 1 DISCHARGE
SUPERHEAT = XXX.X

TEMP = XXX.X F
SAT TEMP = XXX.X F

The next key press displays the System 1 motor thermistor temperatures.
SYS 1 MOTOR TEMPS
T2 = XXX.X F

T1 = XXX.X F
T3 = XXX.X F

If any motor temp sensor is being ignored,


(selectable under Unit Set-up Mode), that
sensors value will be displayed as
XXXXX.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

The next key press displays the compressor speed in


% (0 to100%) and the compressor heater status (ON
or OFF)
SYS 1 COMPRESSOR

SPEED = XXX.X %

HEATER = XXX

The next key press indicates the flash tank level low/
high and the economizer valve % open.
SYS 1

FLASH TANK LEVEL = XXX.X %

ECONOMIZER VALVE = XXX.X %

The next key press displays the condenser liquid line


subcooling and the drain valve position.
SYS 1

CONDENSER SUBCOOLING = XXX.X F

CONDENSER DRAIN VALVE = XXX.X %

The next key press indicates the number of condenser


fans steps that are enabled (1 to 4), if the fans are not
operating on a VSD.
SYS 1

CONDENSER FANS ON = X

If the fans are controlled by an optional VSD, the display will indicate fan speed signal control voltage to
the VSD and the fan speed (0 to 100%).
SYS 1

CONDENSER FANS ON = X
VSD FAN SPEED = XX.X V = XXX %

The next key press will indicate the state of the optional VI solenoids where XXX indicates ON or OFF.
SYS 1

VI STEP SOLENOID 1 = XXX

VI STEP SOLENOID 2 = XXX

The next key press displays the system run time in


days, hours, minutes and seconds.
SYS 1 RUN TIME
XX DAYS XX HOURS XX MINUTES

XX SECONDS

The next key press indicates the status of the RUN Relay where XXX is ON or OFF, the status of the RUN
Permissive signal (flow switch/remote start/stop circuit
2 and 15 of 1TB, SYS 1) or 2 and 16 of 1TB, SYS 2)
and whether the internal software is telling the system
to run (ON or OFF)
SYS 1 RUN SIGNALS
RUN PERM = XXX

RELAY = XXX
SOFTWARE = XXX

System 2 Data Key Operation


System 2 keys function the same as the SYSTEM 1
DATA key except that it displays data for System 2.
On a 2 compressor system, the SYSTEM 3 and SYSTEM 4 data keys will display the following messages:
SYS 3 DATA NOT AVAILABLE

SYS 4 DATA NOT AVAILABLE

JOHNSON CONTROLS

101

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

Sensor Displays
Table 9 lists all the sensors attached to the control
board associated with system data keys. The minimum
and maximum values displayed on the micro display
are provided.

If values exceed the limits in the table, a < (less than)


or > (more than) sign will be display along with the
minimum or maximum value.

Table 9 - SENSOR MIN/MAX OUTPUTS


SYSTEM SENSOR
SENSOR / INPUT

TYPE

MINIMUM VALUE

MAXIMUM VALUE

Suction Pressure

Transducer

0.0 PSIG (0 barg)

125.0 PSIG (8.62 barg)

Condenser Liquid Pressure

Transducer

0.0 PSIG (0 barg)

400.0 PSIG (27.6 barg)

Discharge Pressure

Transducer

0.0 PSIG (0 barg)

400.0 PSIG (27.6 barg)

Oil Pressure

Transducer

0.0 PSIG (0 barg)

400.0 PSIG (27.6 barg)

Switch

Low

High

Condenser Liquid Temp

Thermistor

-4.1 F (-20.06 C)

155.6 F (68.67C)

Leaving Chilled Liquid Temp

Thermistor

-19.1 F (-28.49C)

110.2 F (43.44C)

Return Chilled Liquid Temp

Thermistor

-19.1 F (-28.49C)

110.2 F (43.44C)

Eductor Temp

Thermistor

-4.1 F (-20.06C)

132.8 F (56.00C)

Ambient Air Temp

Thermistor

-4.6 F (-20.33C)

137.9 F (58.83C)

Compressor Motor Temp

Thermistor

-30.2 F (-34.56C)

302.0 F (150.00C)

Flash Tank Level

Discharge Temp

Thermistor

40.3 F (4.61C)

302.6 F (150.33C)

Remote Temp Reset

4 to 20ma, 0 to 10VDC,
0 to 20ma or 2 to 10VDC

0%

100%

Remote Current Limit

4 to 20ma, 0 to 10VDC,
0 to 20ma or 2 to 10VDC

0%

100%

Remote Sound Limit

4 to 20ma, 0 to 10VDC,
0 to 20ma or 2 to 10VDC

0%

100%

102

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

VSD DATA KEY

VSD
DATA KEY

LD10605

General
The VSD DATA key provides the user with displays of
VSD temperatures, voltages, currents, and other operating data. This key has multiple displays, which can
be seen by repeatedly pressing the VSD DATA or the
or (Arrow) keys. An explanation of each message is provided below.
VSD Data Key Operation
The first VSD DATA key press displays the actual VSD
Output Frequency and Command Frequency.
VSD FREQUENCY

ACTUAL = XXX.X HZ
COMMAND = XXX.X HZ

The second key press of the VSD DATA key or the


(ARROW) key displays the calculated compressor %
FLA and measured motor currents in amps for systems
1 and 2. When measuring motor current keep in mind
that measuring inverter PWM current is difficult and
meter error can be significant.
VSD COMP 1 = XXX AMPS

= XXX %FLA

= XXX %FLA

COMP 2 = XXX AMPS

The next key press displays the current limit values


set locally on the panel under the PROGRAM key, remotely by an ISN, and remotely by the Current Limit
input. Any current limits that are inactive will display
XXX instead of a numeric value.
VSD CURRENT LIMIT
ISN = XXX
JOHNSON CONTROLS

LOCAL = XXX %FLA

The next key press displays DC Bus voltage.


VSD

DC BUS VOLTAGE = XXX VDC

The next key press displays the Control Panel/VSD Internal Ambient Temperature and VSD Cooling Pump/
Fan Status. YYY will indicate ON or OFF.
VSD

INTERNAL AMBIENT TEMP = XXX.X F

COOLING SYSTEM STATUS = YYY

The next key press displays the IGBT highest baseplate


temperature.
VSD IGBT BASEPLATE TEMPS T1 = XXX F

T2 = XXX F

The next key press displays the state of the Precharge


signal, where XXX is either ON or OFF.
VSD

PRECHARGE SIGNAL = XXX

The next key press displays the setting of the VSDs


105% FLA overload potentiometer for Compressor #1
and 2. The settings are determined by the adjustment of
the overload potentiometers on the VSD Logic Board.
These pots are factory set and should not require changing unless the circuit board is replaced.
VSD

COMP 1 MOTOR OVERLOAD = XXX AMPS

COMP 2 MOTOR OVERLOAD = XXX AMPS

REMOTE = XXX %FLA

103

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

OPERATING HOURS / START COUNTER KEY

OPERATING HOURS/
START COUNTER
KEY

LD10605

Compressor operating hours and compressor starts are


displayed with a single key press. The maximum value
for both hours and starts is 99,999, at which point they
will roll over to 0. A single display is available under
this key and is displayed below.
HOURS 1=XXXXX, 2=XXXXX

START 1=XXXXX, 2=XXXXX

104

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

HISTORY KEY

HISTORY
KEY

8
LD10605

History Key Operation


The HISTORY key provides the user access to many
unit and system operating parameters captured at the
instant a unit or system safety (fault) shutdown occurs.
The history buffer will also capture system data at the
time of normal shutdowns such as cycling shutdowns.
When the HISTORY key is pressed the following
screen is displayed:
HISTORY

CHOOSE HISTORY TYPE

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

The and (ARROW) keys allow choosing between NORMAL SHUTDOWNS and FAULT SHUTDOWNS. Fault shutdowns provide information on
safety shutdowns, while Normal shutdowns provide
chiller cycling information on temperature (demand),
cycling, remote, system switch, etc., shutdowns that
are non-safety related shutdowns. Once the selection
is made, the (ENTER) key must be pressed to enter
the selection.
Normal Shutdowns History
If the NORMAL SHUTDOWNS History is selected,
the following screen will be displayed:
NORM HIST XX 18-JUN-20004 10:34:58 AM

XX is the normal shutdown number. The display will


provide date and time of the shutdown and the reason
for the cycling shutdown (YYY.).
The operator can view any of the stored 20 single display normal shutdown history buffers. History buffer
number 1 provides the most recent shutdown information and buffer number 20 is the oldest safety shutdown
information saved. The and (ARROW) keys allow
scrolling between each of the history buffers. The
(ARROW) key scrolls to the next normal history shutdown and the (ARROW) key scrolls to the previous
normal history shutdown.
The following display will typically be displayed on a
normal shutdown due to shutdown on lack of cooling
demand.
NORM HIST XX 18-JUN-20004 10:34:58 AM
SYS X COOLING DEMAND SHUTDOWN

Fault Shutdowns History


If the FAULT SHUTDOWNS History is selected, the
following screen will be displayed:
FAULT HIST XX 18-JUN-20004 10:34:58 AM
YYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYY

YYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYY

JOHNSON CONTROLS

105

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

XX is the FAULT HISTORY shutdown number. The


display will provide the date, time, and a description of
the specific type of fault that occurred (YYY.).
The operator can view any of the stored 10 fault history
buffers. History buffer number 1 provides the most recent safety shutdown information and buffer number
10 is the oldest safety shutdown information saved.
The and arrow keys allow scrolling between
each of the FAULT HIST buffers 1 through 10. The
(UP) and (DOWN) arrow keys can be used to scroll
forwards and backwards through the data in a specific
history buffer, once it is displayed.
There is a large amount of data provided under each
history. Rather than scroll sequentially through the data
in a history, which is possible using the arrow key,
the use of a combination of the , , and arrow keys allows fast scrolling to specific data the user
desires to view. To use this feature, the user needs to
be aware the and arrow keys allow scrolling to
the top of the data subgroups. Once a specific history
is selected, the history data is divided under the subgroups of Unit Data, VSD Data, System Data, Hours/
Starts, Setpoints, Options, and Program data. The
and arrow keys allow moving to the first display
under the next or previous subgroup at any time. Once
the first display of a subgroup is displayed, the and
arrow keys allow scrolling though the data in the
subgroup. The arrow key allows scrolling though
the data from first to last. When the last piece of data
is displayed, the next press of the arrow key scrolls
to the first piece of data in the next subgroup. The
arrow key allows going to the previous display.
Listed below is a description of the fault data displays
and their meaning. Data will be displayed in a specific
order starting with the Status Display (System Faults
only), Fault Display, All Fault Display, Unit Data, VSD
Data, System Data, Operating Hours/Starts, Setpoints,
Options, and Program Values at the time of the fault.
Status Fault Type
SYS X COMPRESSOR RUNNING
SYS X YYYYYYYY HIGH DIFF OIL PRESSURE

This message indicates the type of system fault. This


screen is skipped if a UNIT Fault caused the shutdown.

106

Unit Fault Type


UNIT FAULT
LOW AMBIENT TEMP

This message indicates the type of unit fault. This


screen is skipped if a SYSTEM Fault caused the shutdown.
All Fault Data
FAULT HIST XX ALL FAULTS ZZ OF WW
YYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYYY

The ALL FAULT display indicates whether a fault occurred while the unit is shutting down on another fault.
If a control panel fault occurred while the unit is shutting down on a VSD fault before it is reset, the control
panel fault is an ALL FAULT of the VSD fault.
If another VSD fault occurs while the unit is shutting
down on a VSD fault, the next VSD fault will be registered as an ALL FAULT of the VSD fault.
If a VSD fault occurs during the ramp down shutdown
of a control panel fault, the VSD fault is registered as a
new fault, not an ALL FAULT
XX is the history number, YYY is the ALL FAULT
description, ZZ is the ALL FAULT number and WW
is the total number of All Faults for the current history. Sometimes, multiple faults may occur during the
shutdown and multiple displays will be observed when
scrolling through the data using the arrow. In most
cases, the ALL FAULT display will indicate NONE.
The ALL FAULT display will only indicate the cause
of the fault. No additional chiller information will be
displayed under the ALL FAULT, since a snapshot of
all chiller data was taken at the time of the first fault.
Unit Data
Evaporator Leaving and Entering Chilled
Liquid Temperatures
UNIT CHILLED LIQUID LEAVING = XXX.X F

ENTERING = XXX.X F

This message indicates the leaving and entering chilled


liquid temperatures at the time of the fault.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

Ambient Air Temperature

UNIT SOUND LIMIT


UNIT
OUTSIDE AMBIENT AIR TEMP = XXX.X F

LOCAL = XXX %

ISN = XXX

REMOTE = XXX %

This message indicates the ambient air temperature at


the time of the fault.

This message indicates that sound limiting was in effect, the amount, and whether it was local or remotely
limited.

Load / Unload Timers

VSD Data

UNIT

LOAD TIMER = XXX SEC


UNLOAD TIMER = XXX SEC

This message indicates remaining time on the load and


unload timers at the time of the fault.
Chilled Liquid Temperature Error and Rate of
Change
UNIT

TEMP ERROR = XXX.X F

RATE = XXX.X F/M

This message indicates the temperature error between


the actual and the programmed setpoint at the time of
the fault and the rate of temperature change.
Programmed Lead System Selection and
Flow Switch Status
UNIT

LEAD SYSTEM NUMBER = X

FLOW SWITCH = XXX

This message indicates the designated lead system at


the time of the fault and whether the flow switch was
ON (Closed) or OFF (Open) at the time of the fault.
Evaporator Pump and Evaporator Heater
Status
UNIT

EVAP PUMP RUN = XXX

EVAP HEATER = XXX

This message indicates the status of the evaporator


pump and the evaporator heater at the time of the fault.
XXX indicates ON or OFF.
Active Remote Control Status
UNIT ACTIVE REMOTE CONTR0L = XXXXXX

This message indicates whether the system was operating under Active Remote Control (RCC, ISN, LOAD,
TEMP, or SOUND) or standard control (NONE) at the
time of the fault.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

VSD Actual and Command Frequency


VSD FREQUENCY

ACTUAL = XXX.X HZ
COMMAND = XXX.X HZ

This message indicates the VSD actual operating frequency and the command frequency at the time of the
fault. Actual and command may not match due to load/
unload timers, limitation of 1 Hz per load/unload increment, and to allowable acceleration/deceleration of the
motor.
Compressor Amps and %FLA
The message indicates the compressor %FLA and motor currents for systems 1 and 2 at the time of the fault.
COMP 1

= XXX AMPS

= XXX %FLA

COMP 2

= XXX AMPS

= XXX %FLA

VSD Current Limit


VSD CURRENT LIMIT
ISN = XXX

LOCAL = XXX %FLA


REMOTE = XXX %FLA

This message displays the current limit values as set


locally, by an ISN, or a remote current limiting input at
the time of the fault.
DC BUS Voltage
VSD

DC BUS VOLTAGE = XXX VDC

This message displays the DC Bus voltage at the time


of the fault.
VSD Internal Ambient Temp
VSD

INTERNAL AMBIENT TEMP = XXX.X F

COOLING SYSTEM STATUS = YYY

This message displays the VSD/Microprocessor internal ambient cabinet temperature and the cooling system status (ON or OFF) at the time of the fault.

107

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

IGBT Baseplate Temperature

SYS 1 CONDENSER LIQUID TEMP = XXX.X F

VSD IGBT BASEPLATE TEMPS T1 = XXX F


T2 = XXX F

This message displays the IGBT highest baseplate


temperature for 2 and 3 compressor units at the time of
the fault. 4 compressor units display temperatures for
1/3 (T1) and 2/4 (T2).
Precharge Signal Status and VSD Cooling
Status
VSD

PRECHARGE SIGNAL = XXX

This display provides the state of the precharge signal,


where XXX is either ON or OFF at the time of the
fault.
Compressor #1 and #2, 105% FLA Motor
Overload Current Setting
VSD

COMP 1 MOTOR OVERLOAD = XXX AMPS

COMP 2 MOTOR OVERLOAD = XXX AMPS

SUBCOOLING = XXX.X

SAT TEMP = XXX.X F

This message displays the condenser liquid, liquid line


subcooling and saturated discharge temperatures at the
time of the fault.
SYS 1 DISCHARGE
SUPERHEAT = XXX.X

TEMP = XXX.X F
SAT TEMP = XXX.X F

This message displays the system discharge, discharge


superheat and saturated discharge temperatures at the
time of the fault.
Compressor Speed and Heater Status
SYS 1 COMPRESSOR

SPEED = XXX.X %
HEATER = XXX.X F

This message indicates the compressor speed in % and


the heater status at the time of the fault.
System #1 Motor Temperatures
SYS 1 MOTOR TEMPS

T1 = XXX.X F

T3 = XXX.X F

T2 = XXX.X

This message displays the setting of the VSDs 100%


FLA potentiometer for Compressor #1 and #2 at the
time of the fault.

This message displays the System 1 motor thermistor


temperatures at the time of the fault.

System Data

Flash Tank Level and Economizer Position

System #1 Pressures
SYS 1 PRESSURES

OIL = XXXX PSIG

DISCHARGE = XXXX PSIG

This message displays the measured system oil and


discharge pressures at the time of the fault.
SYS 1 PRESSURES

SUCTION = XXXX PSIG

CONDENSER LIQUID = XXXX PSIG

This message displays the measured system suction


and condenser liquid line pressure at the time of the
fault.
System # 1 Temperatures
SYS 1 TEMPERATURES

SYS 1

FLASH TANK LEVEL Y 512 ADC

ECONOMIZER VALVE = XXX.X %

This message displays the flash tank level and the


economizer valve position in % at the time of the fault.
Condenser Subcooling and Condenser Drain
Valve Position
SYS 1

CONDENSER SUBCOOLING = XXX.X F


CONDENSER DRAIN VALVE = XXX.X %

This message displays the condenser subcooling and


the Condenser Drain Valve position at the time of the
fault.

OIL = XXX.X F
EDUCTOR = XXX.X F

This message displays the measured system oil and


eductor temperatures at the time of the fault.

108

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

Condenser Fans

SETPOINTS

SYS 1

CONDENSER FANS ON = X

SYS 1

CONDENSER FANS ON = X

VSD FAN SPEED XX.X V = XXX %

This message displays the number of condenser fans


ON or the optional VSD fan control speed signal to the
inverter and the % of full speed.
VI Step Solenoid
SYS 1

VI STEP SOLENOID 1 = XXX

VI STEP SOLENOID 2 = XXX

This message displays whether the VI solenoids were


ON or OFF at the time of the fault.

LOCAL CONTROL RANGE

= +/- X.X F

This message displays the programmed Control Range


at the time of the fault.
Remote Setpoint and Range
SETPOINTS REMOTE SETPOINT = XXX.X F

REMOTE CONTROL RANGE = +/- X.X F

This message displays the remote setpoint and Control


Range at the time of the fault.
Maximum Remote Temperature Setpoint
SETPOINTS
MAXIMUM REMOTE TEMP RESET = XXX.X F

This message displays the maximum remote reset programmed at the time of the fault.

Compressor #1 Run Time


SYS 1 RUN TIME
XX DAYS XX HOURS XX MINUTES XX SECONDS

Options

This message displays the system run time since the


last start in days, hours, minutes, and seconds at the
time of the fault.

Display Language

System #1 Run Signals

This message displays the language selected at the time


of the fault.

SYS 1 RUN SIGNALS


RUN PERM = XXX

RELAY = XXX
SOFTWARE = XXX

This message displays the System Run Signal Relay


(Relay Output Board) status, Run Permissive Input
status, and the Internal Software (microprocessor command) ON/OFF Start status. The status of each will indicate either ON or OFF.

DISPLAY LANGUAGE
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

Chilled Liquid Cooling Mode


OPTIONS

CHILLED LIQUID COOLING MODE

WATER COOLING

This message displays the chilled liquid temperature


mode (water or glycol) selected at the time of the fault.
Local / Remote Control Mode

System 2 Data
Data for the system 2 at the time of the fault is displayed in the same sequence as the system #1 data.
Compressor Operating Hours and Starts
HOURS 1=XXXXX, 2=XXXXX
START 1=XXXXX, 2=XXXXX

OPTIONS

CHILLED LIQUID COOLING MODE

GLYCOL COOLING

This message indicates whether Local or Remote Control Mode was selected at the time of the fault.
OPTIONS

This message displays compressor operating hours and


compressor starts at the time of the fault.
Chilled Liquid Setpoint Cooling Setpoints
SETPOINTS
LOCAL COOLING SETPOINT

OPTIONS

LOCAL / REMOTE CONTROL MODE


XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

When Remote Control Mode is selected, control of the


Chilled Liquid Setpoint is from a remote device such
as an ISN/BAS controller.

= XXX.X F

This message displays the programmed cooling


setpoint at the time of the fault.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

109

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

If the option is not factory enabled, the option will not


appear.

Display Units Mode


OPTIONS

DISPLAY UNITS
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

This message indicates whether SI (C, barg) or Imperial units (F, PSIG) was selected at the time of the
fault.
System Lead/Lag Control Mode
OPTIONS

LEAD / LAG CONTROL MODE


XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

This message indicates the type of lead lag control selected at the time of the fault. Three choices are available:
Sys 1 Lead
The default mode will be AUTOMATIC.
Remote Temperature Reset
REMOTE TEMP RESET INPUT

XXXXXXXX

This message indicates whether temperature reset was


active or disabled at the chiller keypad at the time of
the fault and if active, the type of reset signal selected.
If the option is not factory enabled, the option will not
appear.

REMOTE CURRENT LIMIT INPUT

XXXXXXXXXXX

This message indicates whether remote current reset


was active or disabled at the chiller keypad at the time
of the fault and if active, the type of reset signal selected.
If the option is not factory enabled, the option will not
appear.
Remote Sound Limit Selection
REMOTE SOUND LIMIT INPUT

XXXXXXXXXXX

This message indicates whether remote sound limit


was active or disabled at the chiller keypad at the time
of the fault and if active, the type of reset signal selected.
110

SUCTION PRESSURE CUTOUT = XXX.X PSIG

This message indicates the he suction pressure cutout


programmed at the time of the fault.
Low Ambient Cutout
PROGRAM
LOW AMBIENT TEMP CUTOUT = XXX.X F

PROGRAM
LEAVING LIQUID TEMP CUTOUT = XXX.X F

This message displays the low leaving chilled liquid


temperature cutout programmed at the time of the fault.
Motor Current Limit
PROGRAM
MOTOR CURRENT LIMIT

= XXX %FLA

This message indicates the motor current limit programmed at the time of the fault.
Pulldown Current Limit

Remote Current Reset

OPTIONS

PROGRAM

Low Leaving Chilled Liquid Temp Cutout

Sys 2 Lead

OPTIONS

Suction Pressure Cutout

This message displays the low ambient temp cutout


programmed at the time of the fault.

Automatic

OPTIONS

Program Values

PROGRAM
PULLDOWN CURRENT LIMIT

= XXX %FLA

This message indicates the pulldown current limit programmed at the time of the fault.
Pulldown Current Limit Time
PROGRAM
PULLDOWN CURRENT LIMIT TIME

= XXX MIN

This message indicates the pulldown current limit time


programmed at the time of the fault.
Condenser Subcooling Setpoint
PROGRAM
SUBCOOLING SETPOINT

= XXX.X F

This message indicates the liquid subcooling setpoint


programmed at the time of the fault.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

Unit ID Number

Eductor Safety Time

PROGRAM

PROGRAM

REMOTE UNIT ID NUMBER

=X

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

EDUCTOR SAFETY TIME

= XXX MIN

This indicates the unit ID # programmed at the time of


the fault.

This message indicates the eductor safety time programmed at the time of the fault.

Sound Limit Setpoint

Motor Temperature Unload

PROGRAM

PROGRAM DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

SOUND LIMIT SETPOINT

= XXX %

MOTOR TEMPERATURE UNLOAD

This indicates the sound limit setpoint programmed at


the time of the fault, if the sound limit option is activated at the factory. If the option is not factory activated,
the display will not appear.

= XXX F

This message indicates the motor temperature programmed at the time of the fault.

Eductor Differential Temperature


PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

EDUCTOR DIFFERENTIAL

= XXX F

This message indicates the programmed eductor differential temperature at the time of the fault.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

111

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

SETPOINTS KEY
SETPOINTS
KEY

LD10605

Setpoints Key Operation


Cooling setpoints and ranges may be programmed by
pressing the SETPOINTS key. The first setpoint entry screen will be displayed as shown below. The first
line of the display will show the chiller default (DEF),
minimum acceptable value (LO) and maximum acceptable value (HI). The second line shows the actual
programmed value. Table 10 also shows the allowable
ranges for the cooling setpoints and Control Ranges.
Note that the Imperial units are exact values while the
Metric units are only approximate.
SETPOINTS

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

LOCAL COOLING SETPOINT

= XXX.X F

Pressing the SETPOINTS key a second time or the


(ARROW) key will display the leaving chilled liquid
Control Range, default, and low/high limits.
SETPOINTS

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

LOCAL CONTROL RANGE

= +/- X.X F

Pressing the SETPOINTS key or the (ARROW) key


a third time will display the remote setpoint and cooling range. This display automatically updates about

112

every 2 seconds. This remote setpoint message is show


below:
SETPOINTS REMOTE SETPOINT = XXX.X F

REMOTE CONTROL RANGE = +/- X.X F

If there is no remote setpoint being utilized, the remote


setpoint value will be displayed as XXXXXX and the
remote Control Range will display XXX.
Pressing the SETPOINTS key or the Arrow key a
fourth time will bring up a screen that allows the Maximum Remote Temperature Reset to be programmed.
This message is show below:
SETPOINTS DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX
MAXIMUM REMOTE TEMP RESET

= XXX.X F

The values displayed under each of the key presses


may be changed by keying in new values and pressing
the (ENTER) key to store the new value into memory. Where more than one value may be keyed in on a
display, a portion of the data that does not need updating may be skipped by pressing the (ENTER) key.
The (ENTER) key must also be pressed after the
last value in the display to store the data into memory.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

The (ARROW) key allows scrolling back through


the setpoints displays.
The minimum, maximum, and default values allowed
under the SETPOINTS key are provided in the following table.
Table 10 - SETPOINT LIMITS
PROGRAM VALUE

MODE
Water Cooling

Leaving Chilled Liquid Setpoint


Glycol Cooling
Leaving Chilled Liquid Control Range

Max. Remote Temperature Reset

LOW LIMIT

HIGH LIMIT

DEFAULT

40.0F

60.0F

44.0F

4.4C

15.6C

6.7C

15.0F

70.0F

44.0F

-9.4C

15.6C

6.7C

1.5F

2.5F

2.0F

0.8C

1.4C

1.1C

2F

40F

20F

1C

22C

11C

JOHNSON CONTROLS

113

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

PROGRAM KEY

PROGRAM
KEY

LD10605

Program Key Operation


Various operating parameters are programmable by the
user. These are modified by pressing the PROGRAM
key and then the (ENTER) key to enter Program
Mode. A listing of the limits of the programmable values is found below. Note that the Imperial units are exact values, while Metric units are only approximate.
The and (ARROW) keys are used to scroll
through the user programmable values. A value may be
changed by keying in the new value and pressing the
(ENTER) key to store the new value in memory. The
cursor will be displayed on the screen when a number
key is pressed. The first line of each message will indicate the chiller default (DEF) value), lowest acceptable
programmable value (LO), and highest acceptable programmable value (HI). The user programmable value
is programmed ON in the second line of the message.
When the PROGRAM key is first pressed, the following display will appear indicating the user is in the program mode:
PROGRAM MODE XXXX
PRESS ENTER KEY TO CONTINUE

Pressing the (ENTER) key again will display the


first programmable selection.

114

Suction Pressure Cutout


PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

SUCTION PRESSURE CUTOUT

= XXX.X PSIG

The suction pressure cutout is protects the chiller from


a low refrigerant condition. It also helps protect from
a freeze-up due to low or no chilled liquid flow. However, it is only a back-up for a flow switch and cannot
protect against an evaporator freeze under many conditions. This cutout is programmable and should generally be programmed for 1.65 barg (24 PSIG) for chilled
water cooling.
The cutout is programmable between 1.65 and 2.48
barg (24.0 and 36.0 PSIG) in the Water Cooling mode
and 0.34 and 2.28 barg (5.0 and 36.0 PSIG) in the Glycol Cooling mode. The default value for both modes
will be 1.65 barg (24.0 PSIG).
Low Ambient Cutout
PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

LOW AMBIENT TEMP CUTOUT

= XXX.X F

The low ambient temp cutout allows programming the


outdoor temperature at which it is desired to shut down
the chiller to utilize other methods of cooling.
The cutout is programmable between -18.9C (-2.0F)
and 10.0C (50F) with a -3.9C (25F) default.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

Low Leaving Liquid Temp Cutout


PROGRAM

Subcooling Setpoint

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

LEAVING LIQUID TEMP CUTOUT = XXX.X F

PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

SUBCOOLING SETPOINT

= XXX.X F

The leaving chilled liquid temp cutout is programmed


to avoid freezing the evaporator due to excessively low
chilled liquid temperatures. The cutout is automatically
set at 2.2 C (36F) in the Water Cooling mode and is
programmable in the Glycol Cooling mode. In the Glycol Cooling Mode, the cutout is programmable from
-11.7C to 2.2C (11.0F to 36.0F) with a default of
2.2C (36.0F).

The liquid subcooling superheat setpoint is programmable from 0.0 to 11.1C (0.0 to 20.0F) with a 2.8C
(5.0F) default. Typically the subcooling control will
be programmed for 2.8C (5.0 F).

Motor Current Limit

For purposes of remote communications, multiple


chillers may be connected to an RS-485 communications bus. To allow communications to each chiller, a
chiller ID number may be programmed into memory.
On a single chiller application, the value will be 0.

PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

MOTOR CURRENT LIMIT

= XXX % FLA

The motor current limit %FLA is programmable. This


allows the microprocessor to limit a system before it
faults on high current. Typically, the limit point is set
at 100%. The unload point is programmable from 30 to
100% with a default of 100%.
Pulldown Current Limit
PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

PULLDOWN CURRENT LIMIT

= XXX % FLA

The pulldown current limit %FLA is programmable.


This allows the microprocessor to limit a system on
pulldown limiting for the purpose of peak time energy savings. Typically, the limit point is set at 100%.
The pulldown limit point is programmable from 30 to
100% with a default of 100%. Be aware when using
pulldown motor current limit, the chiller may not be
able to load to satisfy temperature demand
Pulldown Current Limit Time
PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

PULLDOWN CURRENT LIMIT TIME

= XXX MIN

The pulldown current limit time is programmable.


This allows the microprocessor to limit a system on
pulldown limiting for a defined period of time for the
purpose of peak time energy savings. The pulldown
limit point is programmable from 0 to 255 with a default of 0 Min.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

Unit ID Number
PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

REMOTE UNIT ID NUMBER = X

Sound Limit Setpoint


PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

SOUND LIMIT SETPOINT

= XXX %

The sound limit setpoint is programmable from 0 to


100 % with a 0% default. 0% allows operating up to the
full speed capability of the unit with no sound limiting.
Typically the sound limit control setting will be programmed for 0 % unless sound limiting is utilized on
the chiller. Sound limiting will only permit the unit to
run to a frequency less than the maximum speed capability of the unit. Programming a value of 1% would be
the minimum sound limiting that can be programmed
and 100% will be the maximum. 100% will only allow
the unit speed to operate at the minimum frequency.
Usually, the sound limit % will be programmed somewhere between 0 and 100% according the limiting
needed to satisfy the sound requirements of the site.
Typically, sound limiting will be utilized in areas sensitive to noise during night-time hours. The sound limit
display will only be present if the sound limit option is
programmed at the factory.

115

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

ing oil from the evaporator. A minimum time of 10


minutes is recommended as the program point.

Eductor Differential
PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

EDUCTOR DIFFERENTIAL

= XXX F

Motor Temperature Unload

The eductor temperature differential is programmable


from 0C to 10.0C (0F to 50.0F). The default value
is 5.0F. The programmed temperature assures the micro will sense a loss of educator oil flow, if the temperature differential rises. A small differential of 2.8C
(5.0F) is recommended.
Eductor Safety Time
PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

EDUCTOR SAFETY TIME

= XXXX MIN

The educator safety time allows programming the


time period the system is permitted to run if the safety
threshold is exceeded. The safety time is programmable for 10 minutes to 1000 minutes with 10 minutes as
the default. A minimum safety time is recommended
to assure the compressor is not starved for oil for long
periods of time due to the educator circuit not siphon-

PROGRAM

DEF XXXXX LO XXXXX HI XXXXX

MOTOR TEMPERATURE UNLOAD

= XXX F

The motor temperature unload is programmable from


65.6C (150.0F) to 121.1C 250.0F. The default value is 115.5C (240.0F). The programmed temperature
assures the micro will sense a rise in motor temperature
due to a lack of compressor cooling. If the temperature
rises above the programmed threshold, the system will
unload the compressor by reducing speed. An unload
temperature of 115.5C (240.0F) is recommended to
assure the system does provides maximum capacity.
Default Values
A listing of the low limits, high limits, and default values for each of the programmable values is noted in
each display and can be found in Table 11. Note that
the Imperial units are exact values while the Metric
units are only approximate.

Table 11 - PROGRAMMABLE OPERATING PARAMETERS


PROGRAM VALUE

Suction Pressure Cutout

Low Ambient Temp. Cutout

Leaving Chilled Liquid Temp. Cutout

MODE

LOW LIMIT

HIGH LIMIT

DEFAULT

Water
Cooling

24.0 PSIG

36.0 PSIG

24.0 PSIG

1.65 barg

2.48 barg

1.65 barg

Glycol
Cooling

5.0 PSIG

36.0 PSIG

24.0 PSIG

0.34 barg

2.48 barg

1.65 barg

-2.0F

50.0F

25.0F

-18.9C

10.0C

-3.9C

36.0F

2.2C

Water
Cooling
Glycol
Cooling

11.0F

36.0F

36.0F

-11.7C

2.2C

2.2C

Motor Current Limit

30% FLA

103% FLA

103% FLA

Pulldown Motor Current Limit

30% FLA

100% FLA

100% FLA

Pulldown Motor Current Limit Time

0 Min

255 Min

0 Min

Condenser Subcooling Setpoint

0.0F

20.0F

5.0F

0.0C

11.1C

2.8C

Unit ID Number

Sound Limit
Option Enabled

0%

100%

0%

5.0F

50.0F

15.0F

2.77C

27.8C

8.3C

Sound Limit Setpoint


Eductor Temp Differential

Eductor Safety Time

Motor Temperature Unload

116

10 Min

1000 Min

30 Min*

150.0F

250.0F

240.0F

65.6C

121.1C

115.5C

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

OPTIONS KEY

OPTIONS
KEY

8
LD10605

Options Key Operation

OPTIONS

CHILLED LIQUID COOLING MODE

The OPTIONS key provides the user with a display of


unit configuration and the capability to modify the configuration. These options can only be viewed under the
OPTIONS key. To view the current options settings,
press the OPTIONS key. Each press of the OPTIONS
key or press of the or (ARROW) keys will scroll
to the next option setting. The and (ARROW)
keys allow changing the option choices. The (ENTER) key must be pressed after a selection is made to
save the change in memory.

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

An explanation of each option message is provided below.


Display Language Selection
The display language can be selected for English, Italian, Polish, Hungarian, German, French, Portuguese,
and Spanish.
OPTIONS

DISPLAY LANGUAGE

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

The default language will be English.


Chilled Liquid Cooling Mode Selection

When Water Cooling is chosen, the chilled liquid temperature setpoint can only be programmed from 4C to
21C (40F to 70F).
OPTIONS

CHILLED LIQUID COOLING MODE

WATER COOLING

When Glycol Cooling is chosen, the chilled liquid


temperature setpoint can be programmed from -12C
to 21C (10F to 70F).
OPTIONS

CHILLED LIQUID COOLING MODE

GLYCOL COOLING

The default Chilled Liquid Mode will be WATER


COOLING.
Local / Remote Control Mode Selection
Local or Remote Control Mode allows the user to select the chilled liquid temperature control mode.
OPTIONS

LOCAL / REMOTE CONTROL MODE

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

The Chilled liquid cooling mode can be selected for


Water Cooling or low temperature Glycol Cooling.
JOHNSON CONTROLS

117

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

When LOCAL CONTROL mode is selected, chilled


liquid control is from the keypad of the chiller. In local
mode, a remote device can read system data, but not
reset operating parameters.
OPTIONS

LOCAL / REMOTE CONTROL MODE

LOCAL CONTROL

When REMOTE CONTROL mode is selected, control


of the chilled liquid setpoint is from a remote device
such as an ISN/BAS controller.
OPTIONS

LOCAL / REMOTE CONTROL MODE

REMOTE CONTROL

The default mode will be LOCAL CONTROL.


Display Units Selection
Imperial or SI display units may be selected for data
display.
OPTIONS

DISPLAY UNITS

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

The user may select system operating temperatures and


pressures to be displayed in either SI (C, barg) or Imperial units (F, PSIG).
OPTIONS

DISPLAY UNITS

IMPERIAL

OPTIONS

DISPLAY UNITS

SI

The default mode is IMPERIAL.


System Lead/Lag Control Mode Selection
The operator may select the type of lead/lag control
desired.
OPTIONS

LEAD / LAG CONTROL MODE

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

In most cases, automatic lead/lag will be selected.


When automatic lead/lag is selected, the microprocessor will attempt to balance run time by switching the
lead compressor whenever all compressors are shut
OFF. If a compressor is not able to run when the microprocessor attempts a start, the microprocessor will
select another compressor in an effort to control chilled
liquid temperature. Manual lead/lag allows selecting a
specific compressor to be the lead.

118

OPTIONS

LEAD / LAG CONTROL MODE

AUTOMATIC

The default mode will be AUTOMATIC.


Lag selections of individual systems will appear as:
OPTIONS

LEAD / LAG CONTROL MODE

MANUAL SYS 1 LEAD

OPTIONS

LEAD / LAG CONTROL MODE

MANUAL SYS 2 LEAD

Remote Temperature Reset Selection


Remote temperature reset from an external source may
be tied directly into the chiller microprocessor board.
OPTIONS

REMOTE TEMP RESET INPUT

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

Selections may be made for DISABLED (no signal),


0 to10VDC, 2 to 10VDC, 0 to 20ma, and 4 to 20ma.
OPTIONS

REMOTE TEMP RESET INPUT

DISABLED

OPTIONS

REMOTE TEMP RESET INPUT

0.0 TO 10.0 VOLTS DC

OPTIONS

REMOTE TEMP RESET INPUT

2.0 TO 10.0 VOLTS DC

OPTIONS

REMOTE TEMP RESET INPUT

0.0 TO 20.0 MILLIAMPS

OPTIONS

REMOTE TEMP RESET INPUT

4.0 TO 20.0 MILLIAMPS

The default setting for Remote Temp Reset is DISABLED. This display will only appear if the remote
temperature limit option is enabled under the Unit Setup Mode.
Remote Current Limit Input Selection
Remote current limit from an external source may be
tied directly into the chiller microprocessor board.
OPTIONS

REMOTE CURRENT LIMIT INPUT

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

Selections may be made for DISABLED (no signal),


0 to 10VDC, 2 to 10VDC, 0 to 20ma, and 4 to 20ma.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

OPTIONS

REMOTE SOUND LIMIT INPUT

DISABLED

DISABLED

OPTIONS

REMOTE CURRENT LIMIT INPUT

OPTIONS

REMOTE SOUND LIMIT INPUT

0.0 TO 10.0 VOLTS DC

0.0 TO 10.0 VOLTS DC

OPTIONS

REMOTE CURRENT LIMIT INPUT

OPTIONS

REMOTE SOUND LIMIT INPUT

2.0 TO 10 VOLTS DC

2.0 TO 10.0 VOLTS DC

OPTIONS

REMOTE CURRENT LIMIT INPUT

OPTIONS

REMOTE SOUND LIMIT INPUT

0.0 TO 20.0 MILLIAMPS

0.0 TO 20.0 MILLIAMPS

OPTIONS

REMOTE CURRENT LIMIT INPUT

OPTIONS

REMOTE SOUND LIMIT INPUT

4.0 TO 20.0 MILLIAMPS

4.0 TO 20.0 MILLIAMPS

OPTIONS

REMOTE CURRENT LIMIT INPUT

The default setting for Remote Current Reset is DISABLED. This display will only appear if the remote
current limit option is enabled under the Unit Setup
Mode.

The default setting for Remote Sound Limit is DISABLED. This display will only appear if the remote
sound limit option is enabled under the Unit Setup
Mode.

Remote Sound Limit Selection

Low Ambient Cutout Enable/Disable

Remote sound limit from an external source may be


tied directly into the chiller microprocessor board.

The low ambient cutout may be enabled or disabled.


When enabled, the chiller will cut OFF when the low
ambient cutout is reached. When disabled, the chiller
will run at any temperature.

OPTIONS

REMOTE SOUND LIMIT INPUT

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

Selections may be made for DISABLED (no signal),


0 to10VDC, 2 to 10VDC, 0 to 20ma, and 4 to 20ma.

OPTIONS

LOW AMBIENT TEMPERATURE CUTOUT

ENABLED

OPTIONS

LOW AMBIENT TEMPERATURE CUTOUT

DISABLED

The default setting for the low ambient cutout will be


ENABLED.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

119

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

DATE/TIME AND SCHEDULE KEYS

DATE/TIME
KEY

SCHEDULE
KEY

LD10605

Date/Time Key Operation


When the DATE/TIME key is pressed, the chiller microprocessor will display the date and the time. This
feature is useful and required for using the Daily
Schedule. It is also a valuable tool for troubleshooting
to allow a technician to determine the time of the fault,
which is stored in the history memory buffers. When
the DATE/TIME key is pressed, the first display screen
shown below will be displayed:
CLOCK FRI 18-JUN-2011 10:15:33 AM
DAY OF WEEK

= XXX

Pressing the (DOWN ARROW) key again scrolls to


the day of the month:
CLOCK FRI 18-JUN-2011 10:15:33 AM
DAY OF MONTH

= XX

The day of the month can be selected by keying in the


numerical value to select the day. After the day of the
month is selected, the (ENTER) key must be pressed
to store the data.
A 0 must be typed in to select dates for
days of the 1st through the 9th.

Whenever any changes are made, the (ENTER) key


must be pressed to store the data.
Pressing the or (Arrow) keys allows scrolling to
the next programmed item. Pressing the (DOWN
ARROW) key scrolls to the next item that can be programmed and the (UP ARROW) key scrolls to the
previous item.
The day of the week is the first display and can be
changed by pressing either the or (LEFT OR
RIGHT ARROW) key to select the day. After the day is
selected, the (ENTER) key must be pressed to store
the data.
CLOCK FRI 18-JUN-2011 10:15:33 AM
DAY OF MONTH

120

= XX

Pressing the (DOWN ARROW) key again scrolls


to month:
CLOCK FRI 18-JUN-2011 10:15:33 AM
MONTH

= XXX

The month can be selected by scrolling through the


months with the or arrow keys. After the month is
selected, the (ENTER) key must be pressed to store
the data.
Pressing the (DOWN ARROW) key again scrolls
to the year:

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

CLOCK FRI 18-JUN-2011 10:15:33 AM


YEAR = XXXX

The year can be selected by keying in the numerical


value to select the year. After the year is selected, the
(ENTER) key must be pressed to store the data.
Pressing the (DOWN ARROW) key again scrolls
to the hour:
CLOCK FRI 18-JUN-2011 10:15:33 AM
HOUR = XX

The hour can be selected by keying in the numerical


value for the hour. After the hour is selected, the
(ENTER) key must be pressed to store the data.
One or two 0s must be keyed in for
hours 00-09.

The time format may be displayed in either a 12 hour


or 24 hour format. Selection can be changed by pressing the or (ARROW) keys. The (ENTER) key
must be pressed to store the data.
Schedule Key Operation
The Daily Schedule must be programmed for the unit
start and stop times. To set the schedule, press the
SCHEDULE key. The display will provide a message
allowing access to 2 types of schedule information:
SCHEDULE

CHOOSE SCHEDULE TYPE

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

The schedule types are:


UNIT OPERATING SCHEDULE
(Default selection)
SOUND LIMIT SCHEDULE
(Only if Sound Limiting is enabled by the factory
when the option is installed.)

Pressing the (DOWN ARROW) key again scrolls


to the minute:
CLOCK FRI 18-JUN-2011 10:15:33 AM
MINUTE

= XX

The minute can be selected by keying in the numerical


value for the hour. After the minute is selected, the
(ENTER) key must be pressed to store the data.
One or two 0s must be keyed in for
minutes 00 through 09.

Pressing the (DOWN ARROW) key again scrolls


to AM/PM:
CLOCK FRI 18-JUN-2011 10:15:33 AM
AM/PM

= XX

AM/PM can be selected by pressing the or


(ARROW) keys. After the meridian is selected, the
(ENTER) key must be pressed to store the data.
Pressing the (DOWN ARROW) key again scrolls to
the time format selection:
CLOCK FRI 18-JUN-2011 10:15:33 AM
TIME FORMAT

JOHNSON CONTROLS

= XXXXXXX

The schedule type (UNIT OPERATING SCHEDULE


or SOUND LIMIT SCHEDULE) may be changed by
pressing the (LEFT ARROW) or (RIGHT ARROW) keys followed by the (ENTER) key. The selection must be entered by pressing the (ENTER)
key before a schedule display will appear.
Unit Operating Schedule
The Unit Operating Schedule is used to enable/disable the chiller unit on time of day. The chiller can be
enabled and disabled once each day or it can be programmed to run continuously. Any time the daily or
holiday schedule shuts the chiller down, the running
system(s) will go through a controlled ramped shutdown. If the UNIT OPERATING SCHEDULE is selected under the CHOOSE SCHEDULE display, the
following message will appear:
SCHEDULE

UNIT OPERATING

MON START = 06:00 AM STOP = 10:00 PM

The line under the 0 above is the cursor. If the start


time is wrong, it can be changed by keying in the new
time from the numeric keypad. Once the correct values for the START hour and minute are entered, press
the (ENTER) key. The cursor will then move to the
AM/PM selection. The meridian (AM/PM) value may
be changed by the (LEFT ARROW) or (RIGHT
ARROW) keys and entered by pressing (ENTER)
key. Repeat this process for the STOP time. Once a
schedule is entered, the schedule for the next day will
121

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

appear. The start and stop time of each day may be programmed differently.
To view the schedule without making a change, simply press the SCHEDULE key until the day you wish
to view appears. The (UP ARROW) key will scroll
backwards to the previous screen.
If at any time the schedule is changed for
Monday, all the other days will change to
the new Monday schedule. This means if
the Monday times are not applicable for
the whole week, then the exceptional days
would need to be reprogrammed to the
desired schedule.
To program the chiller for 24 hour operation, program
the start and stop times of each day of the week for
00:00.
After the SUN (Sunday) schedule appears on the display, a subsequent press of the SCHEDULE or (UP
ARROW) key will display the Holiday schedule. This
is a two-part display. The first reads:
SCHEDULE

UNIT OPERATING

HOL START = 00:00 AM STOP = 00:00 PM

The holiday times may be set using the same procedure


as described above for the days of the week. Be sure to
press the (ENTER) key after setting the START and
STOP times to save the change in memory. Pressing
the SCHEDULE key a second time, the display will
show the individual days:
SCHEDULE

UNIT OPERATING

S M T W T F S HOLIDAY NOTED BY *

The line below the empty space is the cursor and will
move to the next or previous empty space when the
(LEFT ARROW) or (RIGHT ARROW) keys and
pressed. To set a day for the Holiday Schedule, the cursor must be moved to the space following the day of
the week. The * key is then pressed and an * will
appear in the space signifying that day as a holiday.
The Holiday schedule must be programmed weekly. If
there is no holiday, the * key is also used to delete the
*. The (ENTER) key is used to accept the holiday
schedule for the entire week.

Sound Limit Schedule


The SOUND LIMIT SCHEDULE allows setting the
day and time when the user desires using the SILENT
NIGHT factory programmed option to limit chiller
loading and fan operation for reduced audible noise in
the surrounding area. If the SOUND LIMIT SCHEDULE is selected under the CHOOSE SCHEDULE display, the following message will appear:
SCHEDULE

SOUND LIMIT

MON START = 06:00 AM

= XXX %

STOP = 10:00 PM

The Sound Limit option can be enabled and disabled


once each day or the chiller can be set to run continuously in this mode for sound limiting whenever the
chiller is operating. When sound limiting is enabled,
the unit will be limited by the Sound Limit setpoint
% as set under the PROGRAM key. XXX in the display above will show the Sound Limit Setpoint % programmed under the PROGRAM key. 0% will cause no
speed reduction, while 100% only allows running at
minimum speed.
The START Time for a specific day (hour and minute)
is entered using the same guidelines used for the start/
stop schedules, and press the (ENTER) key to store
it into memory. The cursor will then move to the AM/
PM selection.
The AM/PM selection may be chosen using the
(LEFT ARROW) or (RIGHT ARROW) keys and
pressing (ENTER) key to store the value.
This process is repeated for the STOP time.
Once the schedule for a specific day is programmed
and entered, the schedule for the next day will appear.
The schedule for each day may be programmed the
same or differently.
To view the schedule without changing it, simply press
the SCHEDULE key or the (DOWN ARROW) key
until the desired day is displayed. The (UP ARROW)
key will scroll backwards to the previous screen.
If the schedule is changed for Monday,
all other days will change to the Monday
schedule. Be aware of this when programming.

The HOLIDAY SCHEDULE is a temporary schedule. Once the schedule is executed, the selected holidays will be cleared
from memory for the following week.

122

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

MANUAL OVERRIDE KEY

MANUAL OVERRIDE
KEY

8
LD10605

Manual Override Key Operation


If the MANUAL OVERRIDE key is pressed during
a schedule shutdown, the STATUS display will display the message below. This indicates that the Daily
Schedule is being ignored and the chiller will start
when chilled liquid temperature allows, Remote Contacts, UNIT switch and SYSTEM switches permitting.
This is a priority message and cannot be overridden by

JOHNSON CONTROLS

anti-recycle messages, fault messages, etc. when in the


STATUS display mode. Therefore, do not expect to see
any other STATUS messages when in the MANUAL
OVERRIDE mode. MANUAL OVERRIDE is to only
be used in emergencies or for servicing. Manual override mode automatically disables itself after 30 minutes.
MANUAL OVERRIDE

123

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

PRINT KEY

PRINT
KEY

LD10605

Print Key Operation


The PRINT key is used to initiate a printout of current operating data (real time data), a complete history
printout of all history (fault) buffers, a printout of all
normal shutdowns (compressor cycling, chiller shutdown, etc.) or history (fault) data printout of a specific
fault. History Buffer 1 will always be the most recent
fault history printout. Printing may also be canceled
by selecting the CANCEL PRINTING option. The following message is displayed when the PRINT key is
pressed.

The following table shows the available printout types.


Table 12 - PRINTOUT TYPES
PRINTOUT TYPES
Operating Data
(Default Selection)
All History Buffers
Normal Shutdowns
History Buffer 1
History Buffer 2
History Buffer 3

PRINT CHOOSE PRINT REPORT

History Buffer 4

History Buffer 5

XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

After pressing the PRINT key, the printout type is


selected by pressing the (LEFT ARROW) or
(RIGHT ARROW) keys until the desired printout is
displayed.

History Buffer 6
History Buffer 7
History Buffer 8
History Buffer 9
History Buffer 10
Cancel Printing

The specific printout is initiated by pressing the


(ENTER) key.

124

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

A sample of the is shown below. The operating data


printout is a snapshot of current system operating conditions when the printout was selected. The sample
shows combined printouts of 2, 3, and 4 circuit units.
The actual printout will only show data for the appropriate chiller type.
Bold italic text below a line of print is not
on the actual printout. Bold italic text
indicates information that may not be
available on all printouts or is additional
information to help explain the difference
in a 2/3 or 4 circuit printout.

UNIT DATA

LEAVING LIQUID TEMP


RETURN LIQUID TEMP
TEMP RATE
COOLING RANGE

49.0 DEGF
58.2 DEGF

XXX.X DEGF/MIN

42.0+/-2.0 DEGF

REMOTE SETPOINT

44.0 DEGF

LEAD SYSTEM

SYS 2

AMBIENT AIR TEMP

74.8 DEGF

FLOW SWITCH

ON

EVAPORATOR PUMP RUN

ON

EVAPORATOR HEATER

Operating Data Printout

OFF

ACTIVE REMOTE CONTROL

YORK INTERNATIONAL CORPORATION

NONE

OPERATING HOURS 1=XXXXX,

YVAA SCREW CHILLER

START COUNTER 1=XXXXX,

OPERATING DATA

2=XXXXX
2=XXXXX

SOFTWARE VERSION

C.ACS.XX.00

NOT RUNNING

ACTUAL FREQUENCY

XXX.X HZ

COMPRESSOR RUNNING

DC BUS VOLTAGE

XXX VDC

SYS 1

2:04:14 PM

30 DEC 11

VSD DATA

COMMAND FREQUENCY

SYS 2

INTERNAL AMBIENT TEMP

OPTIONS

CHILLED LIQUID
LOCAL/REMOTE MODE

LEAD/LAG CONTROL
REMOTE TEMP RESET
REMOTE CURRENT LIMIT

WATER

REMOTE

XXX XXX DEGF

MOTOR OVERLOADS 1/2

XXX XXX AMPS


YYYY XXXZZZ

PRECHARGE SIGNAL

0 TO 10 V

SOFTWARE VERSION

4 TO 20 MA

UNIT SERIAL NUMBER

LOW AMBIENT CUTOUT

ENABLED

COMPRESSOR STATUS

SUCT PRESS CUTOUT

44 PSIG

MOTOR CURRENT

36.0 DEGF

DISCHARGE PRESSURE

PROGRAM VALUES

RUN TIME

25.0 DEGF

SUCTION PRESSURE

MOTOR CURRENT LIMIT

100 %FLA

OIL PRESSURE

PULLDOWN CURRENT LIMIT


PULLDOWN LIMIT TIME
SUBCOOLING SETPOINT
UNIT ID NUMBER
SOUND LIMIT SETPOINT

(if Sound Limiting enabled)

100 %FLA

0 MIN

12.0 DEGF
100%

C.VSD.XX.00

OFF

0- 0- 0- 0 D-H-M-S
0AMPS

0 %FLA

125 PSIG
131 PSIG
130 PSIG

CONDENSER LIQUID TEMP

68.4 DEGF

OIL TEMPERATURE

68.8 DEGF

DISCHARGE TEMPERATURE
SAT SUCTION TEMP
SUBCOOLING

SAT DISCHARGE TEMP

DISCHARGE SUPERHEAT
MOTOR TMP

COMPRESSOR SPEED
FLASH TANK LEVEL
JOHNSON CONTROLS

XXX

SYSTEM 1 DATA

LOW AMBIENT CUTOUT


LEAVING LIQUID CUTOUT

XXX

BASEPLATE TEMPS

AUTOMATIC
DISABLED

XXX.X DEGF

COOLING SYSTEM STATUS

REMOTE SOUND LIMIT

(if Sound Limiting enabled)

XXX.X HZ

68.8 DEGF
71.8 DEGF
3.4 DEGF

74.5 DEGF
6.3 DEGF

XXX.XXXX.XXXX.XDEGF

XXX.X %

> 512 ADC


125

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

COND DRAIN % OPEN


ECONOMIZER % OPEN
CONDENSER FANS ON

XXX.X %
XXX.X %
0

CONDENSER FAN SPEED


COMPRESSOR HEATER

XXX % (vsd)
ON

VI STEP SOLENOID 1

OFF
ON
OFF
OFF

SYSTEM 2 DATA

RUN TIME

MOTOR CURRENT

ON

0-0-15-26 D-H-M-S
104 AMPS

87 %FLA

SUCTION PRESSURE

57 PSIG

DISCHARGE PRESSURE

233 PSIG

CONDENSER LIQUID TEMP

42.9 DEGF

OIL PRESSURE

218 PSIG

DISCHARGE TEMPERATURE

145.5 DEGF

SAT CONDENSER TEMP

31.7 DEGF

SAT DISCHARGE TEMP

112.1 DEGF

OIL TEMPERATURE 102.8 DEGF


SUBCOOLING 11.2 DEGF
DISCHARGE SUPERHEAT
MOTOR TMP

33.4 DEGF

XXX.X XXX.X XXX.X DEGF

COMPRESSOR SPEED

XXX.X%

FLASH TANK LEVEL

< 512 ADC

ECONOMIZER % OPEN
CONDENSER FANS ON

XXX.X%
3

COND DRAIN % OPEN

XXX.X%

CONDENSER FAN SPEED


COMPRESSOR HEATER

XXX% (vsd)
OFF

VI STEP SOLENOID 2
RUN PERMISSIVE
VSD RUN RELAY
VSD SOFTWARE RUN SIGNAL

OFF
ON
OFF
OFF

VI STEP SOLENOID 1

MON START=00:00AM
TUE START=00:00AM

126

OFF

UNIT OPERATING SCHEDULE


W

STOP=00:00AM

FRI START=00:00AM

STOP=00:00AM

THU START=00:00AM
SAT START=00:00AM
HOL START=00:00AM

*=HOLIDAY

STOP=00:00AM
STOP=00:00AM

STOP=00:00AM
STOP=00:00AM
STOP=00:00AM

SOUND LIMIT SCHEDULE

OFF

VI STEP SOLENOID 2
RUN PERMISSIVE
VSD RUN RELAY
VSD SOFTWARE RUN SIGNAL
COMPRESSOR STATUS

WED START=00:00AM

MON
TUE
WED
THU
FRI
SAT
HOL

(if enabled)
START=00:00AM
STOP=00:00AM
START=00:00AM
STOP=00:00AM
START=00:00AM
STOP=00:00AM
START=00:00AM
STOP=00:00AM
START=00:00AM
STOP=00:00AM
START=00:00AM
STOP=00:00AM
START=00:00AM
STOP=00:00AM

History Data Printout


History printouts, when selected, provide stored data
relating to all specific system and chiller operating
conditions at the time of the fault, regardless of whether a lockout occurred. History information is stored in
battery-backed memory on the Chiller Control Board
and is not affected by power failures or resetting of
faults. Whenever a fault of any type occurs, all system
operating data is stored in battery-backed memory at
the instant of the fault. The history printout is similar
to the operating data printout except for the change in
the header information shown below:
YORK INTERNATIONAL CORPORATION
YVAA SCREW CHILLER
HISTORY NUMBER 1
2:04:14 PM

30 APR 11

SYS 1 YYYYYYY
HIGH DSCH PRESS SHUTDOWN
STATUS AT TIME OF SHUTDOWN
SYS 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SYS 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
ALL FAULTS
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

The most recent fault will always be stored as HISTORY BUFFER #1.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 8 - MICROPANEL

SYSTEM SWITCHES KEY

SYSTEM
SWITCHES
KEY

LD10605

System Switches Key Operation


The SYSTEM SWITCHES key allows the operator
to turn individual systems ON and OFF. Safety lockouts are also reset by selecting the respective system
switch RESET. When the SYSTEM SWITCHES key
is pressed, the following message will appear:
SYSTEM SWITCHES

SYS 1 ON / OFF / RESET

=XXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

The display indicates the respective system and its


ON/OFF /reset switch status. The (ARROW)
keys allow scrolling to the next and previous system
switch (System 1 and 2).
SYSTEM SWITCHES

SYS 2 ON / OFF / RESET

=XXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

JOHNSON CONTROLS

The (LEFT ARROW) or (RIGHT ARROW)


keys allow scrolling through the choices of:
SYSTEM OFF (default)
SYSTEM ON
RESET (LOCKOUT)
The switch selection is accepted into memory by pressing the (ENTER) key.
When the RESET selection is made and accepted, it
will not change the position of the switch (either ON
or OFF).
Whenever possible, except in emergencies, always use the associated system
switch to turn off a compressor, which
allows the compressors to go through a
controlled shutdown. Avoid using the
"UNIT" switch to turn off the compressors.

127

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE
GENERAL REQUIREMENTS

Refrigerant Leaks

The units have been designed to operate continuously,


provided they are regularly maintained and operated
within the limitations given in this manual. Each unit
should be included in a routine schedule of daily maintenance checks by the operator/customer, backed up by
regular service inspection and maintenance visits by a
suitably qualified Service Engineer.

Visually check the heat exchangers, compressors and


pipework for damage and gas leaks.

It is entirely the responsibility of the owner to provide for these regular maintenance requirements and/
or enter into a maintenance agreement with a Johnson
Controls service organization to protect the operation
of the unit. If damage or a system failure occurs due
to improper maintenance during the warranty period,
Johnson Controls shall not be liable for costs incurred
to return the unit to satisfactory condition.
This Maintenance section applies to
the basic unit only and may, on individual contracts, be supplemented by additional requirements to cover any modifications or ancillary equipment as applicable.
The Safety section of this manual
should be read carefully before attempting any maintenance operations on the
unit.

Weekly Maintenance
The following maintenance checks should be carried
out on a weekly basis by the operator/customer. Please
note that the units are not generally user serviceable
and no attempt should be made to rectify faults or
problems found during daily checks unless competent
and equipped to do so. If in any doubt, contact your
local Johnson Controls Service Agent.
Unit Status
Press the STATUS key on the keypad and ensure no
fault messages are displayed.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

Operating Conditions
Read the operating pressures and temperatures at the
control panel using the display keys and check that
these are within the operating limitations given in the
manual.
Compressor Oil Level
Compressor oil level will typically run below the bottom of the sight glass. Oil levels will only be visible
in the sight glass after running for periods of 15 to 30
minutes at full compressor speed. Do not run with oil
levels above the sight glass. Be careful when viewing
the sight glass not to confuse a full sight glass with an
empty sight glass.

Refrigerant Charge
Assure there is a level of refrigerant in the evaporator
sight glass while running at Full Load for 15 to 30
minutes.
Adding Charge to a System
A sight glass is located in the evaporator. When optimally charged after running full load, the refrigerant
level should be approximately in the center of the sight
glass. There should be little concern if the level is high
or low in the glass, it should not affect operation.
It is not necessary to weigh charge unless
the entire charge has been lost. The ease
of charging is possible since the microchannel coils hold only a small amount
of refrigerant charge. A charging valve,
located between the fixed orifice and the
evaporator, may be used if charge adjustment is required. Charge should be
added as liquid while circulating water
through the evaporator. If the complete
charge needs to be added, see Refrigerant Removal, Evacuation and Charging a
YVAA Chiller on Page 130 in this section.
Use the valve on the liquid line for adding
the full charge and open the valves per
the procedure.

129

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE

REFRIGERANT REMOVAL, EVACUATION


AND CHARGING A YVAA CHILLER
Refrigerant Removal
The YVAA utilizes a flooded evaporator. Extreme care
must be taken when removing refrigerant to prevent
damage to the evaporator and the chiller. Carefully review the following caution below before proceeding
with the recommended process.
Incorrect removal of refrigerant will result in catastrophic freeze damage to the
evaporator and possible additional damage to other chiller components. Whenever there is water in the evaporator, the
chilled liquid pumps must be ON and
circulating liquid through the evaporator
above minimum recommended flow rates.
When liquid refrigerant is being removed,
monitor the pressure and do not allow the
pressure to drop below the freeze point
of the chilled liquid flowing through the
evaporator until all liquid refrigerant has
been removed from the evaporator and
only gas remains. Once all liquid has
been removed, the remaining refrigerant
vapor can be removed while allowing the
pressure to drop below the freeze point
with the pump circulating liquid through
the evaporator.
To remove refrigerant from the evaporator, follow the
procedure below:
1. Turn the chilled liquid pump ON and assure the
flow is above the minimum recommended flow.
2. Assure all manual valves in the system are open.
Open Condenser Drain and Economizer Feed
valves to 100% in the service mode.
3. Connect the recovery unit and a manifold gauge
to the liquid line feeding the eductor. There may
be a valve in the line or a Schrader fitting on the
eductor filter for this purpose.
4. Connect the recovery unit to a recovery cylinder
sitting on an accurate scale. Turn the recovery
unit ON and observe the liquid refrigerant flowing
from the line into the cylinder. The flow of liquid
should be obvious.

130

5. Monitor the pressure gauge to assure that the pressure does not drop below the freeze point of the
chilled liquid. Throttle the flow as needed with the
manifold gauge valves to prevent pressures from
dropping below the freeze point.
6. Continue to remove the liquid refrigerant while
observing the flow and the pressure. Note the
charge in the system based on the nameplate data
to determine when the charge removal is nearly
complete. Monitor the weight of the recovery
cylinder to determine when the cylinder is full.
Change the cylinder as needed.
7. Continue removing refrigerant until liquid is no
longer observed flowing in the manifold hoses.
8. Once the liquid is removed and no longer visible
in the hose, the remaining gas can be pumped out
with the recovery unit while the pressure is allowed to drop to 0 barg (0 PSIG).
9. Servicing may now be performed on the system
as needed.
Evacuating a System
To evacuate a system, follow the procedure below:
1. Turn the chilled liquid pump ON and assure the
flow is above the minimum recommended flow.
2. Assure all manual values are open. Open the Condenser Drain (Flash Tank Feed) and Economizer
Valves in the Service Mode to 100 %
3. Connect vacuum hoses to as many points as possible. Be sure that at least one connection is made
on both the high and low side of the piping. A connection to the evacuation fitting on the compressor is also recommended. Evacuate the system to
a minimum of 500 microns. Close the valves at
the evacuation points and assure the pressure in
the chiller does not rise more than 50 microns in
10 minutes. Check for leaks if the pressure rises.
Charging Refrigerant into a System
To charge the system with refrigerant, follow the procedure below:
1. With all system valves open and the Condenser
Drain and Economizer Valves open to 100% by
manually opening them in the Service Mode,

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

charge refrigerant vapor into the high side of the


system at the charging port on the liquid line. Continue charging vapor until the pressure is above
the freeze point of the chilled liquid. Once above
the freeze point, liquid can be charged according
to the recommended nameplate charge.
2. Reconnect the water piping to the water boxes.
3. Close the evaporator drain valves and fill the
evaporator with water from the cooling loop.
4. Fill the water loop and check for leaks.
5. Close (0%) the Condenser Drain and Economizer
Valve in the Service Mode. Recycle the chiller
power.
6. Once the system is operating, the charge will
distribute itself throughout the system. Trim the
charge as needed to a level of about midway on
the evaporator sight glass while running full speed
for 15 minutes.
MICROCHANNEL COIL CLEANING
The coil cleaning procedure for microchannel coils is
significantly different than tube and fin type coils. As
such, care must be taken to understand the differences
to avoid damage to the microchannel coil. These differences require a number of DO NOTs that must be
observed:
DO NOT use coil cleaners or any chemical on a
microchannel coil. This can cause severe damage
to the coils.
DO NOT use a pressure washer to clean the coils.
While it is possible to clean a coil with a pressure
washer, its also possible to destroy it.
DO NOT contact the coil with a hard surface such
as a hose nozzle or metal vacuum nozzle or any
other tool.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE

Microchannel coils tend to accumulate more dirt on


the surface, but less dirt inside the coils, which makes
them easier to clean. Follow the three steps below for
cleaning the coils:
1. Remove surface debris such as dirt, leaves, insects, fibers, etc. with a vacuum cleaner having
a soft attachment rather than a metal tube. Compressed air blown from the inside out can also be
used. When brushing debris off the face of the coil
a soft bristle (not wire) brush can be used. Do not
scrape the coil with the vacuum nozzle, air nozzle,
or any other tool.
2. Rinse the coil with tap water. Do not use coil
cleaners. Rinse the coil from the inside out, running water through every passage in the heat exchanger surface until it is clean. Microchannel
coils are stronger than conventional tube and fin
coils, but handle them with care, since you can
cause a leak due to impact. Use a gentle spray
from a spray nozzle with a plastic end or put your
finger on the end of the spray nozzle to reduce
impact and provide a gentle spray.
3. Because of the fin geometry, microchannel coils
retain water more than tube and fin style. It is generally recommended to blow or vacuum out the
rinse water from the coils to speed drying and prevent water pooling.
Scheduled Maintenance
The maintenance operations detailed in the following
table should be carried out on a regular basis by a suitably qualified Service Engineer. It should be noted that
the interval necessary between each minor and major service can vary depending on, for instance, application, site conditions and expected operating schedule. Normally a minor service should be carried out
every three to six months and a major service once a
year. It is recommended that your local Johnson Controls Service Center is contacted for recommendations
for individual sites.

131

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE

MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR


YVAA CHILLERS

PROCEDURE

WEEKLY

Check Oil Level in Oil Separator Sight Glass.

Check Liquid Line Sight Glass/


Moisture Indicator.

Check refrigerant level in the Evaporator Sight Glass while running


full load for 10 to 15 minutes.

Record System Operating Temperatures & Pressures.

Check Condenser Coils for dirt /


debris and clean as necessary.

QUARTERLY

Check Programmable Operating


Setpoints and Safety Cutouts. Assure
they are correct for the application.

Check Compressor and Evaporator Heater operation.

Check for dirt in the Panel. Check


Door Gasket sealing integrity.

**Leak check the Chiller.

SEMIANNUALLY

ANNUALLY

EVERY *
HOURS

**Sample Compressor Oil, check for


Acid, and replace if necessary.

**Disconnect Power Source and


Lock Out. Check tightness of
Power Wiring connections.

Check Glycol concentration on Low


Temp. or other applications where
freezing may be a problem.

VSD Glycol Change.

EVERY 5
YEARS

* Reserved for customer use for any special site requirements.


**This procedure must be performed at the specific time by an industry certified technician who has been
trained and qualified to work on this type of equipment. A record of this procedure be successfully carried out should be maintained on file by
the equipment owner should proof of adequate maintenance be required at a later date for warranty purposes.

132

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE

Table 13 - TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE


PROBLEM

POSSIBLE CAUSE

ACTION
High Voltage to the Chiller is missing.

Supply to the Panel is missing.


NO DISPLAY ON CONTROL PANEL.
UNIT WILL NOT RUN.

LINE FUSE BLOWS.

CHILLER FAULT:
LOW AMBIENT TEMPERATURE

CHILLER FAULT:
HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURE

Check 1FU, 2FU, 4FU, 5FU 17FU, or


19FU.
Check 2T or 10T Transformer.

Line Fuse is blown.

Check Fuses.

Chiller Control Board is defective.

Replace Chiller Control Board.

Display Board defective.

Replace Display Board.

SCR Diode Module is defective.

Check SCR/Diode Module.

IBGT Module is defective.

Check IBGT Module.

VSD Logic Board is defective.

Replace VSD Logic Board.

SCR Trigger Board is defective.

Replace SCR Trigger Board.

Ambient temperature is lower than


the programmed operating limit.

Check the programmed cutout and


determine if it is programmed correctly.

Ambient Sensor is defective.

Check the panel against the thermometer


reading of ambient temperature.

Ambient Temperature is above the


maximum operating limit.

Check outside air temperature.

Ambient Sensor is defective.

Check the Panel Display against


Thermometer reading of Ambient
Temperature at the sensor.
Check for restricted flow.

Leaving chilled liquid temperature drops


faster than the unit can unload.
CHILLER FAULT:
LOW LEAVING CHILLED LIQUID

Check for rapid flow changes.


Water loop is too small.
Flow is below minimum for chiller.

Chilled Water Sensor is defective.

Check Sensor against Temp. Gauge in


water line.
Check Sensor for intermittent operation.
Check Wiring for shorts or opens.

SYSTEM FAULT:
CONTROL VOLTAGE

SYSTEM FAULT:
HIGH OIL TEMPERATURE

System Fuse is blown.

Check respective system Fuse 20FU


or 21FU.

Oil Temperature Sensor is defective.

Check Sensor with infrared to determine if


reading is reasonable.

Condenser Fans NOT operating or running


backwards.

Check Fans.

Coils dirty.

Check and clean Coils.

NOTE: Always remove power to the chiller and assure the DC Bus voltage has bled off.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

133

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE

TABLE 13 - TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE (CONT'D)


PROBLEM

SYSTEM FAULT:
HIGH
DISCHARGE
PRESSURE

SYSTEM FAULT:
HIGH
DISCHARGE
TEMPERATURE

POSSIBLE CAUSE

ACTION

Coils dirty.

Check and clean coils.

Coils are damaged.

Comb out fins.


Check fan fuses.

Fans NOT operating.

Check fan rotation.


Check fan motor/blade.

System is overcharged.

Remove charge and check subcooling.

Discharge Temperature Sensor is defective.

Check Sensor.

Condenser Fans NOT operating or are running backwards.

Check Fans.

Coils dirty.

Check and clean Coils.

High Superheat.

Measure Superheat with gauges and


thermocouple. Determine cause.
Refrigerant charge low. Check subcooling.
Excess charge in system, High discharge
pressure. Check subcooling.

SYSTEM FAULT:
HIGH MOTOR
TEMPERATURE

High Motor temperature input from one of


the sensors.

High Superheat. Drain/Feed Valves NOT


controlling. Isolate cause.
Motor Sensor reading incorrectly. Program
panel to ignore a single sensor.
Economizer Solenoid energized at low
speeds. Valve is leaking through.

SYSTEM FAULT:
LOW
SUCTION
PRESSURE

SYSTEM FAULT:
DISCHARGE
PRESSURE
LIMITING

Low charge.

Check subcooling.

Transducer reads incorrectly.

Check transducer against a gauge.

Suction Temp. Sensor reads incorrectly.

Check sensor against a thermocouple.

Low flow.

Check flow.

Condenser Drain (Flash Tank Feed) Valve


NOT operating.

Check Feed and Drain Valve operation.


Check superheat.

Condenser or Drain (Flash Tank Feed) Valve


defective.

Check Feed and Drain Valve operation.


Check superheat.

Discharge Transducer is defective.

Check transducer against a gauge.

Ambient Temp. very high.

Normal operation.

Fans NOT operating.

Check fan operation.

Remote or local discharge pressure


load limiting is programmed.

Normal operation.

NOTE: Always remove power to the chiller and assure the DC Bus voltage has bled off.

134

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE

TABLE 13 - TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE (CONT'D)


PROBLEM

POSSIBLE CAUSE

ACTION
Ambient temperature is high, normal
response from controller

SYSTEM STATUS:
MOTOR
CURRENT
LIMITING

A high motor current anticipatory control has


activated current limiting

Remote or panel limiting is in effect,


Normal response.
Excess charge in system, adjust charge.
Condenser coils dirty, Clean condenser.
Fans NOT operating. Check fans.

VSD FAULT:
HIGH
BASEPLATE
TEMPERATURE
VSD FAULT:
LOW DC
BUS VOLTAGE

Coolant level low.

Add coolant.

Glycol Pump is defective.

Replace Glycol Pump.

VSD Board is defective

Replace VSD Logic Board.

IBGT Module is defective.

Check defective IGBT Module.

SCR / Diode Module is defective.

Check SCR / Diode Module.

SCR Trigger Board is defective.

Check SCR Trigger Board.

NOTE: Always remove power to the chiller and assure the DC Bus voltage has bled off.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

135

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE

CHILLED LIQUID AND SUCTION TEMPERATURE SENSOR INPUT VOLTAGE


Table 14 - TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE SENSOR (MEASURED SIGNAL TO SHIELD AT THE SENSOR)
TEMP. F (C)

VOLTAGE

TEMP. F (C)

VOLTAGE

TEMP. F (C)

VOLTAGE

16.1 (-8.8)

1.52

35.9 (2.2)

2.19

55.6 (13.1)

2.85

16.7 (-8.5)

1.54

36.5 (2.5)

2.21

56.3 (13.5)

2.87

17.3 (-8.2)

1.56

37.0 (2.8)

2.23

56.9 (13.8)

2.89

17.9 (-7.8)

1.58

37.6 (3.1)

2.25

57.5 (14.2)

2.91

18.5 (-7.5)

1.60

38.2 (3.4)

2.27

58.1 (14.5)

2.93

19.1 (-7.2)

1.62

38.7 (3.7)

2.29

58.7 (14.8)

2.95

19.7 (-6.8)

1.64

39.3 (4.1)

2.30

59.4 (15.2)

2.97

20.3 (-6.5)

1.66

39.9 (4.4)

2.32

60.0 (15.6)

2.99

20.9 (-6.2)

1.68

40.4 (4.7)

2.34

60.6 (15.9)

3.01

21.5 (-5.8)

1.70

41.0 (5.0)

2.36

61.3 (16.3)

3.03

22.1 (-5.5)

1.72

41.6 (5.3)

2.38

61.9 (16.6)

3.05

22.7 (-5.2)

1.74

42.1 (5.6)

2.40

62.5 (16.9)

3.07

23.3 (-4.8)

1.76

42.7 (5.9)

2.42

63.2 (17.3)

3.09

23.9 (-4.5)

1.78

43.3 (6.3)

2.44

63.8 (17.7)

3.11

24.5 (-4.2)

1.80

43.9 (6.6)

2.46

64.5 (18.1)

3.13

25.0 (-3.9)

1.82

44.4 (6.9)

2.48

65.1 (18.4)

3.14

25.6 (-3.6)

1.84

45.0 (7.2)

2.50

65.8 (18.8)

3.16

26.2 (-3.2)

1.86

45.6 (7.5)

2.52

66.5 (19.2)

3.18

26.8 (-2.9)

1.88

46.2 (7.9)

2.54

67.1 (19.5)

3.20

27.3 (-2.6)

1.90

46.7 (8.2)

2.56

67.8 (19.9)

3.22

27.9 (-2.8)

1.91

47.3 (8.5)

2.58

68.5 (20.3)

3.24

28.5 (-1.9)

1.93

47.9 (8.8)

2.60

69.2 (20.7)

3.26

29.0 (-1.7)

1.95

48.5 (9.2)

2.62

69.9 (21.1)

3.28

29.6 (-1.3)

1.97

49.1 (9.5)

2.64

70.6 (21.4)

3.30

30.2 (-1)

1.99

49.7 (9.8)

2.66

71.3 (21.8)

3.32

30.8 (-0.7)

2.01

50.3 (10.2)

2.68

72.0 (22.2)

3.34

31.3 (-0.4)

2.03

50.8 (10.4)

2.70

72.7 (22.6)

3.36

31.9 (-0.1)

2.05

51.4 (10.8)

2.71

73.4 (23)

3.38

32.5 (0.3)

2.07

52.0 (11.1)

2.73

74.2 (23.4)

3.40

33.0 (0.6)

2.09

52.6 (11.4)

2.75

74.9 (23.8)

3.42

33.6 (0.9 )

2.11

53.2 (11.8)

2.77

34.2 (1.2)

2.13

53.8 (12.1)

2.79

34.8 (1.5)

2.15

54.5 (12.5)

2.81

35.3 (1.8)

2.17

55.0 (12.8)

2.83

136

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE

Table 15 - OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR INPUT VOLTAGE


(MEASURED SIGNAL TO SHIELD AT THE SENSOR)
TEMP. F (C)

VOLTAGE

TEMP. F (C)

VOLTAGE

TEMP. F (C)

VOLTAGE

0.24 (-17.6)

0.68

49.8 (9.9)

2.00

93.3 (34.1)

3.31

1.79 (-16.8)

0.71

50.7 (10.4)

2.03

94.4 (34.7)

3.34

3.30 (-15.9)

0.74

51.6 (10.9)

2.06

95.6 (35.3)

3.37

4.76 (-15.1)

0.77

52.5 (11.4)

2.09

96.8 (36)

3.40

6.19 (-14.3)

0.80

53.4 (11.9)

2.11

98.0 (36.7)

3.43

7.58 (-13.6)

0.83

54.3 (12.4)

2.14

99.2 (37.3)

3.46

8.94 (-12.8)

0.85

55.3 (12.9)

2.17

100.4 (38)

3.49

10.3 (-12.1)

0.88

56.2 (13.4)

2.20

101.6 (38.7)

3.52

11.6 (-11.3)

0.91

57.1 (13.9)

2.23

102.9 (39.4)

3.55

12.8 (-10.7)

0.94

58.0 (14.4)

2.26

104.2 (40.1)

3.57

14.1 (-9.9)

0.97

58.9 (14.9)

2.29

105.5 (40.8)

3.60

15.3 (-9.3)

1.00

59.8 (15.4)

2.32

106.8 (41.6)

3.63

16.5 (-8.6)

1.03

60.7 (15.9)

2.35

108.1 (42.3)

3.66

17.7 (-7.9)

1.06

61.6 (16.4)

2.38

109.5 (43.1)

3.69

18.9 (-7.3)

1.09

62.6 (17)

2.41

110.9 (43.8)

3.72

20.0 (-6.7)

1.12

63.5 (17.5)

2.44

112.3 (44.6)

3.75

21.2 (-6)

1.15

64.4 (18)

2.47

113.8 (45.4)

3.78

22.3 (-5.4)

1.18

65.3 (18.5)

2.50

115.2 (46.2)

3.81

23.4 (-4.8)

1.21

66.3 (19.1)

2.52

116.7 (47.1)

3.84

24.4 (-4.2)

1.24

67.2 (19.5)

2.55

118.3 (47.9)

3.87

25.5 (-3.6)

1.26

68.1 (20.1)

2.58

119.9 (48.8)

3.90

26.6 (-3)

1.26

69.1 (20.6)

2.61

121.5 (49.7)

3.93

27.6 (-2.4)

1.32

70.0 (21.1)

2.64

123.2 (50.7)

3.96

28.7 (-1.8)

1.35

70.9 (21.6)

2.67

124.9 (51.6)

3.98

29.7 (-1.3)

1.38

71.9 (22.2)

2.70

126.6 (52.6)

4.01

30.7 (-0.7)

1.41

72.8 (22.7)

2.73

128.4 (53.6)

4.04

31.7 (-0.2)

1.44

73.8 (23.2)

2.76

130.3 (54.6)

4.07

32.7 (0.4)

1.47

74.8 (23.8)

2.76

33.7 (0.9)

1.50

75.8 (24.3)

2.82

34.7 (1.5)

1.53

76.7 (24.8)

2.85

35.7 (2.1)

1.56

77.7 (25.4)

2.88

36.7 (2.6)

1.59

78.7 (25.9)

2.91

37.6 (3.1)

1.62

79.7 (26.5)

2.93

38.6 (3.7)

1.65

80.7 (27.1)

2.96

39.6 (4.2)

1.67

81.7 (27.6)

2.99

40.5 (4.7)

1.70

82.7 (28.2)

3.02

41.4 (5.2)

1.73

83.6 (28.7)

3.05

42.4 (5.8)

1.76

84.6 (29.2)

3.08

43.3 (6.3)

1.79

85.7 (29.8)

3.11

44.3 (6.8)

1.82

86.7 (30.4)

3.13

45.2 (7.3)

1.85

87.8 (31)

3.16

46.1 (7.8)

1.88

88.9 (31.6)

3.19

47.0 (8.3)

1.91

90.1 (32.3)

3.22

48.0 (8.9)

1.94

91.1 (32.8)

3.25

48.9 (9.4)

1.97

92.2 (33.4)

3.28

JOHNSON CONTROLS

137

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE

Table 16 - PRESSURE TRANSDUCER OUTPUT VOLTAGE


(MEASURED SIGNAL TO RETURN AT THE TRANSDUCER)
SUCTION PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
(125 PSIG)

138

DISCHARGE CONDENSER LIQUID PRESSURE AND


DISCHARGE PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
(400 PSIG)

PRESSURE

VOLTAGE

PRESSURE

VOLTAGE

0.50

0.50

0.66

25

0.75

10

0.82

50

1.00

15

0.98

75

1.25

20

1.14

100

1.50

25

1.30

125

1.75

30

1.46

150

2.00

35

1.62

175

2.25

40

1.78

200

2.50

45

1.94

225

2.75

50

2.10

250

3.00

55

2.26

275

3.25

60

2.42

300

3.50

65

2.58

325

3.75

70

2.74

350

4.00

75

2.90

375

4.25

80

3.06

400

4.50

85

3.22

90

3.38

95

3.54

100

3.70

105

3.86

110

4.02

115

4.18

120

4.34

125

4.50

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE

Table 17 - MOTOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR RESISTANCE (CHECK AT THE MOTOR)


TEMP.
F (C)

R NOMINAL
(OHMS)

R TOL
( %)

RMIN
(OHMS)

RMAX
(OHMS)

-4 (-20)

97,062

5.00

92,209

101,915

5 (-15)

77,941

4.60

69,586

76,296

14 (-10)

55,391

4.20

52,996

57,643

23 (-5)

42,324

3.85

40,695

43,954

32 (0)

32,654

3.50

31,511

33,797

41 (5)

25,396

3.15

24,596

26,196

50 (10)

19,903

2.80

19,346

20,461

59 (15)

15,713

2.50

15,321

16,106

68 (20)

12,493

2.20

12,218

12,768

77 (25)

10,000

2.00

9,800

10,200

86 (30)

8,056

2.40

7,863

8,250

95 (35)

6,531

2.70

6,354

6,707

104 (40)

5,326

3.00

5,166

5,485

113 (45)

4,368

3.25

4,226

4,510

122 (50)

3,602

3.50

3,476

3,728

131 (55)

2,986

3.75

2,874

3,098

140 (60)

2,488

4.00

2,389

2,588

149 (65)

2,083

4.25

1,995

2,172

158 (70)

1,753

4.50

1,674

1,832

167 (75)

1,481

4.75

1,411

1,551

176 (80)

1,257

5.00

1,194

1,321

185 (85)

1,071

5.20

1,016

1,127

194 (90)

916.9

5.40

867.4

966.4

203 (95)

787.7

5.60

743.6

831.9

212 (100)

679.3

5.80

639.9

718.7

221 (105)

587.9

6.00

552.6

623.2

230 (110)

510.6

6.20

479.9

542.3

239 (115)

445.0

6.40

416.5

473.5

248 (120)

389.0

6.60

363.4

414.7

257 (125)

341.2

6.70

318.4

364.1

266 (130)

300.2

6.90

279.5

320.9

275 (135)

264.9

7.10

246.1

283.7

284 (140)

234.4

7.30

217.3

251.5

293 (145)

208.0

7.40

192.6

223.3

302 (150)

185.0

7.50

171.1

198.9

JOHNSON CONTROLS

139

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

SECTION 10 - DECOMMISSIONING, DISMANTLING AND DISPOSAL


Never release refrigerant to the atmosphere when emptying the refrigerating
circuits. Suitable retrieval equipment
must be used. If reclaimed refrigerant
cannot be reused. It must be returned to
the manufacturer.
Never discard used compressor oil, as it
contains refrigerant in solution. Return
used oil to the oil manufacturer.

Never discard used compressor oil, as it contains refrigerant in solution. Return used oil to the oil manufacturer.

If glycol or similar solutions have been


used in the water system, or chemical additives are contained, the solution MUST
be disposed of in a suitable and safe manner. Under NO circumstances should any
system containing glycol or similar solutions be drained directly into domestic
waste or natural water systems.
After draining, the water pipework can be disconnected and removed.
Packaged units can generally be removed in one piece
after disconnection as above. Any fixing down bolts
should be removed and then the unit should be lifted
from position using the points provided and equipment
of adequate lifting capacity.

GENERAL

Reference should be made to SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION on Page 23 for unit installation instructions,
SECTION 9 - MAINTENANCE on Page 129 for unit
weights and SECTION 3 - HANDLING AND STORAGE on Page 19 for handling.

Isolate all sources of electrical supply to the unit including any control system supplies switched by the
unit. Ensure that all points of isolation are secured in
the OFF position. The supply cables may then be disconnected and removed. For connection points refer to
SECTION 4 - INSTALLATION.

Units which cannot be removed in one piece after disconnection as above must be dismantled in position.
Special care should be taken regarding the weight and
handling of each component. Where possible units
should be dismantled in the reverse order of installation.

Remove all refrigerant from each system of the unit


into a suitable container using a refrigerant reclaim or
recovery unit. This refrigerant may then be re-used, if
appropriate, or returned to the manufacturer for disposal. Under NO circumstances should refrigerant be
vented to atmosphere. Drain the refrigerant oil from
each system into a suitable container and dispose of
according to local laws and regulations governing the
disposal of oily wastes. Any spilt oil should be mopped
up and similarly disposed of.

Residual refrigerant oil and glycol or


similar solutions may remain in some
parts of the system. These should be
mopped up and disposed of as described
above.

Unless otherwise indicated, the operations described


below can be performed by any properly trained maintenance technician.

Isolate the unit heat exchanger from the external water systems and drain the heat exchanger section of the
system. If no isolation valves are installed it may be
necessary to drain the complete system.

It is important to ensure that whilst components are being removed the remaining parts are supported in a safe
manner.
Only use lifting equipment of adequate
capacity.

After removal from position the unit parts may be disposed of according to local laws and regulations.

JOHNSON CONTROLS

141

10

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

NOTES

142

JOHNSON CONTROLS

FORM 201.28-NM1.1
ISSUE DATE: 8/29/2013

The following factors can be used to convert from


English to the most common SI Metric values.

Table 18 - SI METRIC CONVERSION


MEASUREMENT

MULTIPLY ENGLISH UNIT

BY FACTOR

TO OBTAIN METRIC UNIT

Capacity

Tons Refrigerant Effect (ton)

3.516

Kilowatts (kW)

Power

Horsepower

0.7457

Kilowatts (kW)

Flow Rate

Gallons / Minute (gpm)

0.0631

Liters / Second (l/s)

Feet (ft)

0.3048

Meters (m)

Inches (in)

25.4

Millimeters (mm)

Weight

Pounds (lbs)

0.4538

Kilograms (kg)

Velocity

Feet / Second (fps)

0.3048

Meters / Second (m/s)

Feet of Water (ft)

2.989

Kilopascals (kPa)

Pounds / Square Inch (psi)

6.895

Kilopascals (kPa)

Length

Pressure Drop

TEMPERATURE
To convert degrees Fahrenheit (F) to degrees Celsius
(C), subtract 32 and multiply by 5/9 or 0.5556.
Example: (45.0F - 32) x 0.5556 = 27.2C
To convert a temperature range (i.e., a range of 10F)
from Fahrenheit to Celsius, multiply by 5/9 or 0.5556.
Example: 10.0F range x 0.5556 = 5.6 C range

JOHNSON CONTROLS

143

P.O. Box 1592, York, Pennsylvania USA 17405-1592


Copyright by Johnson Controls 2013
Form 201.28-NM1.1 (813)
Issue Date: August 29, 2013
Supersedes 201.28-NM1.1 (812)

800-861-1001
www.johnsoncontrols.com

Subject to change without notice. Printed in USA


ALL RIGHTS RESERVED

You might also like